blob: f05edcee3fdba5862b17777d259c05b6dc629e32 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Faulet7d4c2f02024-04-05 20:18:49 +02006 2024/04/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +0000593.11. HTTPClient tuning
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020060
614. Proxies
624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
64
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200665.1. Bind options
675.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200685.3. Server DNS resolution
695.3.1. Global overview
705.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100726. Cache
736.1. Limitation
746.2. Setup
756.2.1. Cache section
766.2.2. Proxy section
77
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
797.1. ACL basics
807.1.1. Matching booleans
817.1.2. Matching integers
827.1.3. Matching strings
837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
867.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
877.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200887.3.1. Converters
897.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
907.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096
978. Logging
988.1. Log levels
998.2. Log formats
1008.2.1. Default log format
1018.2.2. TCP log format
1028.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001038.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001048.2.5. Error log format
1058.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001068.3. Advanced logging options
1078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1098.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1118.4. Timing events
1128.5. Session state at disconnection
1138.6. Non-printable characters
1148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1168.9. Examples of logs
117
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001189. Supported filters
1199.1. Trace
1209.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001229.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001239.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001249.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001259.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200126
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012710. FastCGI applications
12810.1. Setup
12910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
13010.1.2. Proxy section
13110.1.3. Example
13210.2. Default parameters
13310.3. Limitations
134
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013511. Address formats
13611.1. Address family prefixes
13711.2. Socket type prefixes
13811.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
1401. Quick reminder about HTTP
141----------------------------
142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
145on almost anything found in the contents.
146
147However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
148formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
149correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
150
151
1521.1. The HTTP transaction model
153-------------------------------
154
155The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100156to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100157from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
158connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159will involve a new connection :
160
161 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
162
163In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
164establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
165by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
166length.
167
168Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
169to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
170however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
171response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
172header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
177power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
178but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200179a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
183second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
184page :
185
186 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
187
188This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
189latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
190correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
191the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100192server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200194The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
195This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
196streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100197parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
198carry the stream identifier.
199
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200200
201HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200202head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200203streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
Amaury Denoyelle96c45632024-05-24 17:31:26 +0200204other streams. QUIC also provides connection migration support but currently
205haproxy does not support it.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
208connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
209leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
211processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
212waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200213
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200214HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
216 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100217 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200219 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100220
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222
2231.2. HTTP request
224-----------------
225
226First, let's consider this HTTP request :
227
228 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100229 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
231 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
232 3 User-agent: my small browser
233 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
234 5 Accept: image/png
235
236
2371.2.1. The Request line
238-----------------------
239
240Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
241
242 - a METHOD : GET
243 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
245
246All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
247which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
248followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
249is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
250desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
251the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
252
253The URI itself can have several forms :
254
255 - A "relative URI" :
256
257 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
258
259 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
260 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
261
262 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
263
264 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
265
266 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
267 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
268 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
269 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
270 must accept this form too.
271
272 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
273 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
274 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
277 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
278 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
279 other protocols too.
280
281In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
282mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
283on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
284It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
285specific to the language, framework or application in use.
286
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100288assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.2.2. The request headers
292--------------------------
293
294The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
295beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
296an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
297Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
298values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
299encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
300the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
301define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100303Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100305"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200306as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
307normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
308representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
309HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310
311The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
312that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
313is one valid form of empty line.
314
315Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
316headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
317about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
318application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
319
320Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
323 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
324 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
325
326
3271.3. HTTP response
328------------------
329
330An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
331messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
332
333 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100334 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
336 2 Content-length: 350
337 3 Content-Type: text/html
338
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
340codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
341response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
343the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
344following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
345sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
346(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
347correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
348such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
349state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400350over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100351if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
352information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356------------------------
357
358Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
359
360 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
361 - a status code : 200
362 - a reason : OK
363
364The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
366 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
367 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
368 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
369 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000371Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100372"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
374messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
375or "Authentication Required".
376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100377HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
379 Code When / reason
380 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
381 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100384 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
385 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 400 for an invalid or too large request
387 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
388 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100390 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100392 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
393 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400396 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100397 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200399 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200400 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
401 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
402 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
403
404The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4054.2).
406
407
4081.3.2. The response headers
409---------------------------
410
411Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
412the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
413details.
414
415
4162. Configuring HAProxy
417----------------------
418
4192.1. Configuration file format
420------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200421
422HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
423
424 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700426 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
430a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100431
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100432 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
433
434 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
435
436 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
437 tab characters
438
439 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
440 keyword sequences listed in this document
441
442 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
443 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
444 parts of the configuration, or expressions
445
446 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
447 are supported
448
449 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
450 section
451
452This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
453generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
454figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
455
456First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
457the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
458a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
459word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
460follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
461the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
462the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
463the parts that need to be addressed.
464
465A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
466requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
467extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
468the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
469section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
470section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
471not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
472
473A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
474each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
475a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
476start a new one.
477
478Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
479that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
480applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
481"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
482processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
483ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
484which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
485In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
486of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
487identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
488such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4892, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
490
491 listen foo
492 bind :80
493
494 listen bar
495 bind :81
496
497Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
498spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
499of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
500following configurations are strictly equivalent:
501
502 global#this is the global section
503 daemon#daemonize
504 frontend foo
505 mode http # or tcp
506
507and:
508
509 global
510 daemon
511
512 # this is the public web frontend
513 frontend foo
514 mode http
515
516The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
517new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
518other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
519section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
520section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
521at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
522
523Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
524are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
525editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
526support automatic indent.
527
528In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
529positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
530modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
531anymore, and is not recommended.
532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200533
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005342.2. Quoting and escaping
535-------------------------
536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
538that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
539possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
540in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
541('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100543This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
544very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
545the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
546also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
547delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
548word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
549remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200550
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100551If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
552(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
553
554Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
555backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
557 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
558 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
559 \\ to use a backslash
560 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
561 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
562
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100563In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
564C-language representation:
565
566 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
567 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
568 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
569 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
570
571Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
572or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
573of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
577 # hash as a comment start
578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
580evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
581dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
582backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
585character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
586is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100588As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
589entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
590name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
591represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300592hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200593
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100594 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
600 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100608 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
610 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100612 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300613 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200614
615 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200617 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
619 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
620 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
621 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
622
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100623There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
624necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
625by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
626they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
627escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
628characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
629case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
630if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
631own quotes.
632
633The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600634quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500635not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100636quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
637
638Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
639arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
640
641 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
643
644Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
645"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
646cannot write:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
649
650because we would like the string to cut like this:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
653 |---------|----|-|
654 arg1 _/ / /
655 arg2 __________/ /
656 arg3 ______________/
657
658but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
659parenthesis then garbage:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662 |--------|--------|
663 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
664 trailing garbage _________/
665
666The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
667quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
668processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
669this word:
670
671 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
674
675So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
676still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
677the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
678the second level:
679
680 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
681 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
682 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
683 |---------||----|-|
684 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
685 arg2=blah ___________/ /
686 arg3=g _______________/
687
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500688Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100689double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
690
691 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
692 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
693 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
694 |---------||----|-|
695 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
696 arg2 ___________/ /
697 arg3 _______________/
698
699When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
700appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
701string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
702thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
703
704 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
705 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
706 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
707 |-------------| |-----||-|
708 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
709 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
710 arg3 ______________________/
711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400712Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600713that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
715single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
716level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
717
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600718Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
719if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
720or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
721
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
723 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
724 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
725
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100726When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
727double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600728and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100729a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
730a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
731the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
732regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
733around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
734more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200735
736
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007372.3. Environment variables
738--------------------------
739
740HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
741interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
742configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
743optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
744shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200745underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
746list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
747arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100748before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
749use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
750next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
751existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200752
753 Example:
754
755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
756
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100757 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200758
759 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
760
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200761Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
762file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200763
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200764* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
765 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
766
767* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
768 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
769 directory.
770
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100771* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
772 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
773 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
774
775 Example:
776 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
777 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
778
779* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
780 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
781
782* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
783 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
784
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200785* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
786
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500787* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200788 processes, separated by semicolons.
789
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500790* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200791 CLI, separated by semicolons.
792
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100793* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
794 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
795 updating the binary and reloading.
796
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500797* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
798 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
799 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
800 branch number.
801
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200802In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
803regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
804only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
805
806* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
807
808* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
809 starting at one.
810
811* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
812 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
813 first section.
814
815These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
816if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
817section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
818"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
819proxies.
820
821This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
822logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
823to name some config objects like servers for example.
824
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200825See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200826
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100827
8282.4. Conditional blocks
829-----------------------
830
831It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
832some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
833ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
834configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
835versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
836preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
837text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
838lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
839switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
840are defined to form conditional blocks:
841
842 - .if <condition>
843 - .elif <condition>
844 - .else
845 - .endif
846
847The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
848as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
849matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
850there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
851only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
852".elif" of a block.
853
854Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
855ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
856as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
857
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200858Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
859See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
860
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200861The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
862expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100863
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
865 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200866 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200867 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530868 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
869 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200870 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
871 from left to right until one returns false
872 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
873 from right to left until one returns true
874
875Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
876operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200877
878The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
879
880 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
881 exists, regardless of its contents
882
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200883 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
884 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
885 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
888 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100889 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200890
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200891 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
892 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
893 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
894 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
895
896 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
897 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
898 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
899 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
900
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100901 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
902 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100903 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
904 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
905 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100908
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200909 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
910 listen mwcli_px
911 bind :1111
912 ...
913 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200915 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
916 bind :80
917 .endif
918
919 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200922 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200923 .endif
924
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200925 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200926 bind :443 ssl crt ...
927 .endif
928
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200929 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
930 profiling.memory on
931 .endif
932
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200933 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
934 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200939 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
941 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
942 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
943
944Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
945"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
946fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
947provide advice to the user.
948
949Example:
950
951 .if "${A}"
952 .if "${B}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=1"
954 .elif "${C}"
955 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
956 .elif "${D}"
957 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
958 .else
959 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
960 .endif
961 .else
962 .notice "A=0"
963 .endif
964
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200965 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
966 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
967
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100968
9692.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200970----------------
971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100972Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100973values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
974otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
975numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
976for every keyword. Supported units are :
977
978 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
979 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
980 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
981 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
982 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
983 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
984
985
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009862.6. Size format
987----------------
988
989Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
990These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
991otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
992numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
993for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
994
995 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
996 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
997 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
998
999Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
1000
1001
10022.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001003-------------
1004
1005 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1006 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1007 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1008 global
1009 daemon
1010 maxconn 256
1011
1012 defaults
1013 mode http
1014 timeout connect 5000ms
1015 timeout client 50000ms
1016 timeout server 50000ms
1017
1018 frontend http-in
1019 bind *:80
1020 default_backend servers
1021
1022 backend servers
1023 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1024
1025
1026 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1027 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1028 global
1029 daemon
1030 maxconn 256
1031
1032 defaults
1033 mode http
1034 timeout connect 5000ms
1035 timeout client 50000ms
1036 timeout server 50000ms
1037
1038 listen http-in
1039 bind *:80
1040 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1041
1042
1043Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1044
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001045 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001046
1047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010483. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049--------------------
1050
1051Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1052are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1053of them have command-line equivalents.
1054
1055The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1056
1057 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001058 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - 51degrees-cache-size
1060 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001061 - 51degrees-difference
1062 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001063 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1064 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001065 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1066 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001067 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001069 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001070 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001071 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001073 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - description
1075 - deviceatlas-json-file
1076 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001078 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001079 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001080 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001081 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001083 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001085 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1086 - h1-case-adjust
1087 - h1-case-adjust-file
1088 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001089 - hard-stop-after
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001090 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp
1091 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001092 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001093 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001094 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001095 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001097 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001098 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001099 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001100 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001101 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001102 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001103 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001104 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001105 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001107 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001108 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001109 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001110 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001111 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001112 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001114 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001116 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001120 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001121 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - ssl-default-server-options
1123 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001124 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001125 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001126 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001127 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001128 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001129 - stats
1130 - strict-limits
1131 - uid
1132 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001134 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001135 - user
1136 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001137 - wurfl-data-file
1138 - wurfl-information-list
1139 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001142 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001143 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001144 - maxcompcpuusage
1145 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001147 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001149 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001150 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001151 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001152 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001153 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001155 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001156 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001157 - nokqueue
1158 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001159 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001161 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001162 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001163 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001164 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001165 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001166 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001167 - tune.buffers.limit
1168 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001170 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001171 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001172 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001173 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001174 - tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001175 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1176 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001177 - tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001178 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1179 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001180 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001181 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001182 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001183 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001185 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001186 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001187 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001188 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001189 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001190 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001191 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001192 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001193 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1194 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001195 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1196 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001197 - tune.maxaccept
1198 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001199 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001200 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001201 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001202 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001203 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001204 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1205 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001206 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001209 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frederic Lecaillefd9424d2024-02-16 15:28:30 +01001210 - tune.quic.reorder-ratio
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001211 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001212 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001213 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1214 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001215 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001216 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001217 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001218 - tune.sndbuf.client
1219 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001220 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001221 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001222 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1223 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1224 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001225 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1226 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001227 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001228 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1229 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001230 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1232 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001233 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001234 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001235 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1237 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001238 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1239 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001242 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001244 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +00001246 * HTTPClient
1247 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
1248 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1249 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1250 - httpclient.retries
1251 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1252 - httpclient.ssl.verify
1253 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012553.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256------------------------------------
1257
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125851degrees-data-file <file path>
1259 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1260 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001263 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001264
126551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1266 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1267 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1268 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001271 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001272
127351degrees-property-separator <char>
1274 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1275 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001278 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001279
128051degrees-cache-size <number>
1281 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1282 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1283 By default, this cache is disabled.
1284
1285 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001286 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001287
128851degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1289 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1290 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1291
1292 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001293 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001294
129551degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1296 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1297 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001300 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001301
130251degrees-drift <number>
1303 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1304
1305 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001306 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001307
130851degrees-difference <number>
1309 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1310
1311 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001313
131451degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1315 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1316 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1317
1318 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001321ca-base <dir>
1322 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001323 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1324 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1325 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327chroot <jail dir>
1328 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1329 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1330 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1331 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1332 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001334
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001335close-spread-time <time>
1336 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1337 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1338 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1339 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1340 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1341 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1342 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1343 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001344 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1345 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1346 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1347 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1348 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001349
1350 Arguments :
1351 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001352 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1353 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001354
1355 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1356 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1357 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1358
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001359 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001360
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001361cluster-secret <secret>
1362 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1363 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1364 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1365 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001366 tokens.
1367
1368 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1369 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1370 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001371
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001372cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001373 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1374 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1375 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1376 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1377 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001378
1379 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1380
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001381 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001382 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1383 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1384 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1385 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1386 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1387 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1388 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001389 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1390 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1391 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1392 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1393 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1394 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001395
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001396 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1397 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1398 on the machine's word size.
1399
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001400 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1401 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001402 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1403 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001404 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001405 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1406 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001407
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001408 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1409 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1410 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1411 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1412 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001413
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001414 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001415 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001416 # first 4 CPUs
1417
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001418 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1419 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420 # word size.
1421
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001422 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001423 # and so on.
1424 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1425 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1426 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001427 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001428
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001429 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1430 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1431 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1432 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001433
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001434 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1435 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1436 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001437
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001438 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1439 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1440 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1441 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1442 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1443
1444 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1445 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1446 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001447 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1448 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1449 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1450 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001451
1452
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001453crt-base <dir>
1454 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001455 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1456 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458daemon
1459 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1460 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001461 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1462 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001464default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001465 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001466 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1467 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1468 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1469 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1470 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1471 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1472 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1473 not start with a slash ('/'):
1474 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1475 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1476
1477 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1478 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1479 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1480 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1481 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1482 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1483 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1484 each of them.
1485
1486 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1487 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1488 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1489 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1490 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1491 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1492 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1493 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1494
1495 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1496 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001497 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001498 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1499 made easily relocatable.
1500
1501 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1502 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1503 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1504 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1505 consistent across all configuration files.
1506
1507 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1508 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1509 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1510 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1511 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1512 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1513 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1514 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1515
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001516description <text>
1517 Add a text that describes the instance.
1518
1519 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1520 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1521 "<" and ">" characters.
1522
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001523deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1524 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001526
1527deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001529 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1530
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001531deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001532 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1533 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1534 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001535
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001536deviceatlas-separator <char>
1537 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1538 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1539
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001540expose-experimental-directives
1541 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1542 the config file will be rejected.
1543
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001544external-check [preserve-env]
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001545 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1546 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001547 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1548 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1549 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001550 By default, the checks start with a clean environment which only contains
1551 variables defined in the "external-check" command in the backend section. It
1552 may sometimes be desirable to preserve the environment though, for example
1553 when complex scripts retrieve their extra paths or information there. This
1554 can be done by appending the "preserve-env" keyword. In this case however it
1555 is strongly advised not to run a setuid nor as a privileged user, as this
1556 exposes the check program to potential attacks. See "option external-check",
1557 and "insecure-fork-wanted", and "insecure-setuid-wanted" for extra details.
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001558
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001559fd-hard-limit <number>
1560 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1561 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1562 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1563 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1564 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1565 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1566 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1567 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1568 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1569 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1570 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1571 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1572
1573 global
1574 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1575 fd-hard-limit 50000
1576
1577 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001580 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1582 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001583 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001584 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001585 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001586
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001587grace <time>
1588 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1589
1590 Arguments :
1591 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1592 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1593 soft-stop operation.
1594
1595 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1596 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1597 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1598 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1599 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1600 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1601 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1602 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1603 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1604
1605 Example:
1606
1607 global
1608 grace 10s
1609
1610 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1611 frontend ext-check
1612 bind :9999
1613 monitor-uri /ext-check
1614 monitor fail if { stopping }
1615
1616 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1617 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1618 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1619 SIGUSR1 signal.
1620
1621 Example:
1622
1623 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1624 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1625 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1626 frontend ext-check
1627 bind :9999
1628 monitor-uri /ext-check
1629 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1630
1631 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1632
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001633group <group name>
1634 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1635 See also "gid" and "user".
1636
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001637h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1638 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1639
1640 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1641 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1642 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1643 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1644 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1645 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1646 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1647
1648 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1649 option may be set.
1650
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001651h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1652 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1653 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1654 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1655 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001656 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001657 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1658 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1659 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1660 specified in a proxy.
1661
1662 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1663 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1664 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1665 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1666 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1667 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1668 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1669
1670 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1671 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1672 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1673 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1674 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1675
1676 Example:
1677 global
1678 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1679
1680 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1681 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1682
1683h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1684 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1685 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1686 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1687 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1688 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1689 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1690 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1691 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1692
1693 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1694 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1695 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1696
1697 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1698 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1699
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001700h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1701 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1702 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1703 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1704 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1705 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1706 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1707 the keyword with "no'.
1708
1709hard-stop-after <time>
1710 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1711
1712 Arguments :
1713 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1714 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1715 SIGUSR1 signal.
1716
1717 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1718 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1719 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1720
1721 Example:
1722 global
1723 hard-stop-after 30s
1724
1725 See also: grace
1726
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001727harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp { on | off }
1728harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic { on | off }
1729 Toggle per protocol protection which forbid communication with clients which
1730 use privileged ports as their source port. This range of ports is defined
1731 according to RFC 6335. Protection is inactive by default on both protocols.
1732
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001733insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001734 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001735 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1736 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1737 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1738 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1739 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1740 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1741 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001742 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001743 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1744 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1745 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1746 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1747 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1748 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1749 disable it.
1750
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001751insecure-setuid-wanted
1752 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1753 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1754 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1755 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001756 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001757 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001758 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001759 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1760 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001761 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001762 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1763 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1764 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1765 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1766
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001767issuers-chain-path <dir>
1768 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1769 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1770 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001771 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001772 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1773 "issuers-chain-path".
1774 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1775 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1776 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1777 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1778 will share the chain in memory.
1779
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001780limited-quic
1781 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1782 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1783 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1784 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1785 when this setting is set.
1786
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001787localpeer <name>
1788 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1789 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1790 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1791 the configuration parsing.
1792
1793 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1794 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1795
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001796log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001797 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001798 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001799 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001800 configured with "log global".
1801
1802 <address> can be one of:
1803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001804 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001805 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1806 port).
1807
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001808 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1809 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1810 port).
1811
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001812 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001813 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1814 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001816
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001817 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1818 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1819 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1820 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1821 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1822 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1823 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1824 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1825 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1826 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001827 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001828 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1829 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1830 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001831 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1832 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001833
1834 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1835 "fd@2", see above.
1836
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001837 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1838 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1839 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1840 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1841 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001845
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001846 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1847 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1848 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1849 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1850 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1851 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1852 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1853 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1854 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1855 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1857 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001858
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001859 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1860 one of the following :
1861
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001862 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1863 field is stripped. This is the default.
1864 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1865 rfc3164.
1866
1867 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001868 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1869
1870 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1871 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1872
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001873 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1874 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1875 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1876 designed to be used with a local log server.
1877
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001878 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1879 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1880 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1881 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1882 logger consumes.
1883
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001884 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1885 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1886 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1887 used with a local log server.
1888
1889 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1890 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1891 designed to be used with a local log server.
1892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1895 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1896 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1897
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001898 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1899 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1900 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1901 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1902 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1903
1904 <sample_size>
1905 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1906 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1907 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1908 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1909 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1910
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001911 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001912
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001913 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1914 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1915 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001917 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1918 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1919 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1920 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001921
1922 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001923 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1924 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1925 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1926 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1927 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1928 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001929
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001930 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001931
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001932log-send-hostname [<string>]
1933 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1934 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1935 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1936 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1937 the logs.
1938
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001939log-tag <string>
1940 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1941 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1942 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001943 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001944
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001945lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001946 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1947 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1948 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1949 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1950 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1951 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001952 used multiple times.
1953
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001954 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001955 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001956 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001957 other files.
1958
1959 local args = table.pack(...)
1960
1961lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001962 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1963 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1964 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1965 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1966 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1967 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1968 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1969 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1970 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1971 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1972 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1973 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1974 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1975 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1976 times.
1977
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001978 See lua-load for usage of args.
1979
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001980lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1981 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1982 variable.
1983 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1984 to "path".
1985
1986 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1987 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1988 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1989 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1990 will be checked earlier.
1991
1992 As an example by specifying the following path:
1993
1994 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1995 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1996
1997 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1998 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1999 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2000 paths if that does not exist either.
2001
2002 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2003 documentation.
2004
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002005master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002006 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
2007 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
2008 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002009 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002010 or daemon mode.
2011
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002012 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2013 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2014 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2015 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2016 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002017
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002018 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002019
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002020mworker-max-reloads <number>
2021 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002022 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002023 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2024 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2025 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2026
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002027nbthread <number>
2028 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002029 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2030 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2031 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2032 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2033 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2034 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2035 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002036
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002037no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002038 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2039 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2040 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2041
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002042numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002043 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2044 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2045 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2046 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2047 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2048 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2049 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2050 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2051 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2052 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002055 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2056 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2057 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2058 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002059
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002060pp2-never-send-local
2061 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2062 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2063 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2064 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2065 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2066 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2067 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2068 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2069 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2070 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2071 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2072
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002073presetenv <name> <value>
2074 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2075 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2076 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2077 and "unsetenv".
2078
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002079prealloc-fd
2080 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2081 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2082 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2083 to expand its data structures.
2084
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002085resetenv [<name> ...]
2086 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2087 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2088 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2089 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2090 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2091 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2092 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2093 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2094
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002095server-state-base <directory>
2096 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002097 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2098 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002099
2100server-state-file <file>
2101 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2102 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2103 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2104 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2105 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2106 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2107 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2108 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002109 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2110 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002111
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002112set-dumpable
2113 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2114 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2115 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2116 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2117 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2118 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2119 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2120 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2121 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2122 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2123 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2124 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2125 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2126 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2127 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2128 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2129 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2130 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2131
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002132set-var <var-name> <expr>
2133 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2134 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2135 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2136 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2137 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2138 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002139 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002140 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2141 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2142
2143 Example:
2144 global
2145 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2146 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2147 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2148
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002149set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2150 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2151 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2152 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2153 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2154 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2155 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2156 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2157 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2158 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02002159 Please see section 8.2.6 for details on the custom log-format syntax.
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002160
2161 Example:
2162 global
2163 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2164 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2165
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002166setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2167 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2168 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2169 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2170 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2171 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2172 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2173 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2174 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2175 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2176 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2177 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2178 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2179 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2180 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002182setenv <name> <value>
2183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2186 and "unsetenv".
2187
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002188ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2190 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002191 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002192 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002193 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2194 information and recommendations see e.g.
2195 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2196 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2197 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2198 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002199
2200ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2202 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002203 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2204 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2205 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
2206 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2207 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2208 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. This setting might accept TLSv1.2
2209 ciphersuites however this is an undocumented behavior and not recommended as
2210 it could be inconsistent or buggy.
2211 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
2212 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
2213
2214 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
2215
2216 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
2217 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
2218 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
2219 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
2220 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
2221
2222 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2223
2224 Example:
2225 global
2226 ssl-default-bind-ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
2227 ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002228
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002229ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2231 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2232 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2233 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2234 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2235 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2236 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2237 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2238 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2239 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2240 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2241 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2242 with a middlebox is required.
2243
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002244ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2246 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2247 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2248 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2249 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2250
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002251ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2253 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2254 keyword to see available options.
2255
2256 Example:
2257 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002258 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002259
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002260ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2262 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2263 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2264 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2265 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2266 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2267 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2268 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2269 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2270 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2271 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2272 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2273 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2274 with a middlebox is required.
2275
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002276ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2278 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002279 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002280 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002281 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2282 information and recommendations see e.g.
2283 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2284 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2285 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2286 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2287 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002288
2289ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2292 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2293 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2294 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002295 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002296 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2297 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2298 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002299
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002300ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2302 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2303 keyword to see available options.
2304
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002305ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2307 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2308 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002309 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002310 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002311 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002312 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2313 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2314 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2315 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002316 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2317 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2318 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2319
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002320ssl-propquery <query>
2321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2322 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2323 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2324 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2325 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2326 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2327 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2328 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2329 was not found.
2330
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002331ssl-provider <name>
2332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2333 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2334 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2335 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2336 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2337 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002338
2339 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002340 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2341 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2342 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2343 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2344 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002345
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002346 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2347 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2348 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2349 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002350
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002351 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2352
2353ssl-provider-path <path>
2354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2355 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2356 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2357 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2358 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2359 defined.
2360 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002361
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002362ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2363 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2364 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002365 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002366 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002367 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2368
2369 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002370
2371 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2372 and won't try to remove them.
2373
2374 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2375
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002376ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002377 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002378 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2379 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2380 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002381
2382 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2383 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2384 optimize the startup time.
2385
2386 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2387 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2388 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2389
2390 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002391 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002392
2393 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002394 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2395 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002396
2397 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2398 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2399 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2400 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2401 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002402 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002403
2404 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002405 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002406 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2407 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2408 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2409 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2410 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002411 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002412
2413 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2414
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002416 a cert bundle.
2417
2418 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2419 separately in several "crt".
2420
2421 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2422 since files are loading separately.
2423
2424 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2425 required to commit them.
2426
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002427 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002428 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002429
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002430 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2431 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2432 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002433
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002434 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2435 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2436 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002437
2438 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002439 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2440 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002441
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002442 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2443 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2444
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002445 The default behavior is "all".
2446
2447 Example:
2448 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2449 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2450 ssl-load-extra-files none
2451
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002452 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2453 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002454
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002455ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2456 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2457 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2458 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2459
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002460ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002461 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002462 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2463 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2464 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2465 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2466 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2467 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002468 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002469
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002470stats maxconn <connections>
2471 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2472 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2473
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002474stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2475 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2476 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2477 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002478 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002479 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002480
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002481 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2482 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2483 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002484
2485stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2486 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2487 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002488 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002489
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002490strict-limits
2491 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2492 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2493 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2494 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2495 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002496
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002497thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2498 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2499 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2500 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2501 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2502 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2503 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2504 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2505 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2506 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2507
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002508thread-groups <number>
2509 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2510 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002511 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2512 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2513 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2514 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2515 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002516
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002517trace <args...>
2518 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2519 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2520 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2521 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2522 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2523 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2524 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2525 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2526 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2527 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2528 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2529 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2530 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2531 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2532 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2533 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2534 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002537 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2539 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2540 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2541
2542ulimit-n <number>
2543 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2544 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002545 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2546 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002548 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2549 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2550 manually specify this value.
2551
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002552 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2553
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002554unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2555 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2556
2557 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2558 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2559 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2560 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2561 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002562 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002563 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2564 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2565 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2566 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2567
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002568unsetenv [<name> ...]
2569 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2570 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2571 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2572 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2573 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2574 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2575 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2576
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002577user <user name>
2578 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2579 See also "uid" and "group".
2580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002581node <name>
2582 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2583
2584 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2585 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2586 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2587 traffic.
2588
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002589wurfl-cache-size <size>
2590 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2591 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2592 - "0" : no cache is used.
2593 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002594
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002595 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2596 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002597
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002598wurfl-data-file <file path>
2599 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2600 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2601
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002602 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002603 with USE_WURFL=1.
2604
2605wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2606 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2607 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2608 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2609
2610 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2611
2612 Valid WURFL properties are:
2613 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2614
2615 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2616 device.
2617
2618 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2619 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2620
2621 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2622 particular web request.
2623
2624 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2625 used Libwurfl API version.
2626
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002627 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2628 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2629
2630 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2631 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2632
2633 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2634
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002635 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002636 with USE_WURFL=1.
2637
2638wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2639 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2640 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2641
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002642 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002643 with USE_WURFL=1.
2644
2645wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2646 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2647 thus before the chroot.
2648
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002649 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002650 with USE_WURFL=1.
2651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026523.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002653-----------------------
2654
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002655busy-polling
2656 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2657 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2658 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2659 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2660 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2661 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2662 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2663 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2664 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2665 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2666 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2667 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2668 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2669 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2670 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2671 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2672 "poll" pollers.
2673
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002674 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2675 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2676 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2677
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002678max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002679 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002680 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2681 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2682 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2683 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2684 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2685 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2686 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2687
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002688maxcompcpuusage <number>
2689 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2690 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2691 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2692 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2693 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2694 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2695 and from introducing high latencies.
2696
2697maxcomprate <number>
2698 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2699 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2700 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2701 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2702 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2703 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2704 default value.
2705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002706maxconn <number>
2707 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2708 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2709 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002710 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2711 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2712 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2713 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002714 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2715 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2716 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2717 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2718 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002719 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2720
2721 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002722
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002723maxconnrate <number>
2724 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2725 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2726 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2727 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2728 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2729 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2730 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2731 fairness.
2732
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002733maxpipes <number>
2734 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2735 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2736 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2737 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2738 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2739 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2740
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002741maxsessrate <number>
2742 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2743 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2744 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2745 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2746 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2747 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2748 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2749 fairness.
2750
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002751maxsslconn <number>
2752 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2753 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2754 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2755 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2756 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2757 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2758 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002759 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2760 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2761 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2762 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002763 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002764 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2765 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002766
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002767maxsslrate <number>
2768 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2769 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2770 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2771 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2772 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2773 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2774 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2775 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2776 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2777 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2778
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002779maxzlibmem <number>
2780 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2781 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2782 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002783 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2784 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2785 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2786
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002787no-memory-trimming
2788 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2789 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2790 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2791 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2792 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2793 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2794 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2795 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2796 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2797 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2798 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2799 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2800 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2801 not suffer from such a problem.
2802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002803noepoll
2804 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2805 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002806 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002807
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002808noevports
2809 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2810 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2811 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2812 also "nopoll".
2813
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002814nogetaddrinfo
2815 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2816 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2817
2818nokqueue
2819 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2820 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2821 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002823nopoll
2824 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2825 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002827 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2828 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002829
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002830noreuseport
2831 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2832 command line argument "-dR".
2833
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002834nosplice
2835 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002836 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002837 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002838 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002839 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2840 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2841 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2842 "option splice-response".
2843
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002844profiling.memory { on | off }
2845 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2846 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2847 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2848 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2849 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2850 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2851 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2852 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2853 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2854
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002855profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2856 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2857 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2858 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2859 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002860 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002861 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2862 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2863 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2864 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2865
2866 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2867 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2868 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2869 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2870 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002871 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2872 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2873 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2874 CLI.
2875
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002876spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002877 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2878 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2879 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2880 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2881 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2882 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002885 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002887 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002888 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002889 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2890 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2891 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002892 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2893 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002894 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2895 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2896 openssl configuration file uses:
2897 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2898
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002899 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2900 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2901 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2902 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2903
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002904ssl-mode-async
2905 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002906 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002907 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2908 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002909 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002910 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002911 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002912
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002913tune.buffers.limit <number>
2914 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2915 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2916 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2917 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2918 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002919 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002920 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2921 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2922 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2923 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2924 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2925 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2926 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2927 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002928 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002929
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002930tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2931 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2932 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2933 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002934 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002935
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002936tune.bufsize <number>
2937 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2938 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2939 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2940 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2941 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2942 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2943 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002944 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2945 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002946 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002947 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002948 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002949 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2950 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002951
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002952tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2953 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2954 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2955 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2956 this value. The default value is 1.
2957
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002958tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2959 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2960 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2961 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2962 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2963 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2964 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2965 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2966 appear on a line before this directive.
2967
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002968tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002969 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2970 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2971 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002972 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2973 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2974 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002975
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002976tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2977 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2978 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2979 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2980 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2981 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2982
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01002983tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold <number>
2984 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a backend connection, where
2985 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
2986 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
2987 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
2988 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 servers may
2989 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
2990 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
2991 effective without affecting slightly bogus servers.
2992
2993 See also: tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold, bc_glitches
2994
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02002995tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
2996 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
2997 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
2998 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
2999 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3000 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3001 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3002 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003003
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003004 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3005
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003006tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3007 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3008 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3009 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3010 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3011 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3012 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3013 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3014 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3015 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3016 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3017 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3018 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3019
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01003020tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold <number>
3021 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a frontend connection, where
3022 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
3023 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
3024 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
3025 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 clientss may
3026 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
3027 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
3028 effective without affecting slightly bogus clients.
3029
3030 See also: tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold, fc_glitches
3031
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003032tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3033 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3034 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3035 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3036 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3037 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3038 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3039 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3040 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3041 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003042 parallel to large uploads.
3043
3044 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003045
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003046tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3047 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3048 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3049 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3050 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3051 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3052 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3053 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3054 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3055
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003056tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3057 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3058 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3059 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3060 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3061 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3062 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3063 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3064 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3065 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3066 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3067 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3068 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3069 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3070
3071 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3072 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3073 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3074 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3075 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3076 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3077 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3078 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3079 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3080 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3081
3082 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3083 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3084 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3085 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3086 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3087 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3088 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3089 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3090
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003091tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3092 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3093 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3094 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3095 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3096 change it.
3097
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003098tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003099 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3100 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3101 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3102 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3103 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3104 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3105 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3106 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3107 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3108 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003109
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003110tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003111 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003112 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003113 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3114 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3115 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3116 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3117 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3118 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3119 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003120
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003121tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003122 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003123 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003124 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003125 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3126 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3127 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3128 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3129
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003130tune.http.cookielen <number>
3131 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3132 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3133 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3134 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3135 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3136 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3137 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3138 to change this value.
3139
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003140tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3142 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003143 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003144 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003145 configuration directives too.
3146 The default value is 1024.
3147
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003148tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3149 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3150 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3151 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3152 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3153 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3154 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003155 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3156 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3157 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003158
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003159tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3160 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3161 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3162 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3163 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3164 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3165 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003166 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3167 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3168 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3169 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3170 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003171
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003172tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003173 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003174 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3175 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3176 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3177 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003178 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003179 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003180 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003181 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3182
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003183tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3184 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3185 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3186 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3187 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3188 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3189 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3190 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3191 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3192 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3193 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3194 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3195 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3196 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3197 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3198 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3199 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3200 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3201 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3202 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3203 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3204 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003205 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3206 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003207
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003208tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3209 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3210 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3211 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003212 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3213 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003214 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3215 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3216 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3217 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3218 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3219 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3220 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3221 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3222 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003223 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003224 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003225
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003226tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3227 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003228 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003229 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3230 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003231 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003232 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3233 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3234
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003235tune.lua.maxmem
3236 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3237 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3238 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3239 memory.
3240
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003241tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3242 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003243 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3244 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003245 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003246
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003247tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3248 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3249 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3250 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3251 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3252 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3253 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3254 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3255
3256 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3257 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3258 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3259 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3260 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3261 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3262
3263 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3264 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3265 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3266 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3267 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3268 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3269
3270 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3271 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3272 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3273 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3274 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3275 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3276 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3277
3278 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3279 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3280
3281 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3282 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3283 time will also be accounted for.
3284
3285 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3286 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3287 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3288 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3289
3290 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3291 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3292 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3293 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3294
3295 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3296
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003297tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3298 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3299 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3300 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003301 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003302
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003303tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3304 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3305 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3306 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3307 check servers.
3308
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003309tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3310 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3311 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3312
3313 Defaults to 'on'.
3314
3315tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3316 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3317 stderr.
3318 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3319
3320 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3321 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3322 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3323
3324 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3325 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3326
3327 Defaults to 'on'.
3328
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003329tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003330 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3331 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003332 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3333 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3334 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3335 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3336 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3337 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3338 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3339 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3340 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003341
3342tune.maxpollevents <number>
3343 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3344 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3345 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3346 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3347 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003349tune.maxrewrite <number>
3350 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3351 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3352 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3353 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3354 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3355 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3356 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3357 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3358 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3359 bufsize.
3360
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003361tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3362 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3363 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3364 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3365 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3366 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3367 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3368 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3369 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3370 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3371 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3372 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3373 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3374 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3375 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3376
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003377tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3378 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3379 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3380 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3381 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3382 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3383 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3384 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3385 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3386 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003387 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3388 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003389 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3390 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3391 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3392 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3393 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3394 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3395 setting this parameter to 0.
3396
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003397tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3398 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3399 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3400 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3401 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3402 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3403 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3404 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3405
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003406tune.pipesize <number>
3407 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3408 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3409 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3410 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3411 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3412 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3413
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003414tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3415 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003416 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003417 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3418 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3419 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3420 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003421 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003422
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003423tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3424 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003425 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003426 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3427 default is 20.
3428
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003429tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003430 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3431 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3432 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3433 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003434 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003435
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003436tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003437 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3438 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3439 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3440 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3441 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3442 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3443 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3444
3445 The default value is 30000.
3446
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003447tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003448 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3449 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3450 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3451 requests.
3452
3453 The default value is 100.
3454
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003455tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003456 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3457 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3458
3459 The default value is 10.
3460
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003461tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3462 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3463 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3464
3465 The default value is 50.
3466
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003467tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003468 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003469 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3470 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003471 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3472 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003473 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3474 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003475
3476 The default value is 100.
3477
3478 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3479 information about QUIC retry.
3480
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003481tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003482 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3483 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3484 own socket.
3485
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003486 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3487 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003488 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003489 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3490 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3491 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003492 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003493 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3494 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003495 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3496 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003497
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003498 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3499 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3500 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003501 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003502 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003503
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003504tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3505tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3506 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3507 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3508 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003509 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003511 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3512 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3513
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003514tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003516 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3517 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3518 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3519 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3520
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003521tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003522 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003523 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3524 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3525 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3526 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3527 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3528 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3529 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003530
3531tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3532 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003533 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003534 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3535 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3536 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3537 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3538 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3539 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3540 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003541
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003542tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3543tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3544 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3545 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3546 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003547 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003549 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3550 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3551 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3552 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003554
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003555tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003556 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003557 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3558 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3559 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3560 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3561 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3562 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3563 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3564 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3565 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003566 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3567 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003568
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003569tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3570tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3571 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3572 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3573 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3574 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3575
3576tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3577 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3578 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3579 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3580 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3581 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3582 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3583 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3584 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3585 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3586 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3587 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3588 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3589
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003590tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003591 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003592 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3593 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3594 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3595 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3596 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3597
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003598tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3599 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3600 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3601 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3602 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3603
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003604tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3605 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3606 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3607 performances. This is disabled by default.
3608
3609 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3610 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3611
3612 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3613
3614 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3615
3616 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3617
3618 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3619 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3620 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3621
3622 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3623 converted.
3624
3625 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3626 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3627 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3628 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3629 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3630 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3631 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003632 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3633 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003634
3635 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3636
3637 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3638 only need this line:
3639
3640 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3641
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003642tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3643 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003644 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003645 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3646 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3647 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3648 being used for too long.
3649
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003650tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003651 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3652 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3653 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3654 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3655 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3656 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3657 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3658 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3659 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3660 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3661 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3662 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3663 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003664
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003665tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3666 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3667 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3668 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3669 1000 entries.
3670
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003671tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3672 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3673 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3674 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3675 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3676
3677tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3678 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3679 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3680 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3681 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3682 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3683 information about the auto update mechanism.
3684
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003685tune.stick-counters <number>
3686 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3687 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003688 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003689 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3690 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3691 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3692 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3693 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3694 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3695 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3696 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3697 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3698 entirely disable stick-counters).
3699
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003700tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003701tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003702tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3703tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3704tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003705 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3706 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3707 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3708 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3709 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3710 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3711 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3712 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003713
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003714 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3715 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3716 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3717 all available space is consumed.
3718 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3719 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3720 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003721
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003722tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3723 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003724 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003725 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003726 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003727 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3728
3729tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3730 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3731 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003732 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3733 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037353.3. Debugging
3736--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003737
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003738anonkey <key>
3739 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3740 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3741 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003742 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3743 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003744
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003745quick-exit
3746 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3747 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3748 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3749 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3750 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3751 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3752 do so by developers.
3753
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003754quiet
3755 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3756 line argument "-q".
3757
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003758zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003759 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003760 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3761 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3762 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3763 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3764 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3765
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037673.4. Userlists
3768--------------
3769It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3770http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3771it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3772
3773userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003774 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003775 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3776
3777group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003778 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003779 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3780 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3781
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003782user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3783 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003784 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3785 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003786 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3787 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3788 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3789 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003790
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003791 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3792 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3793 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3794 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3795 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3796 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3797 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003798 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003799 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003800
3801 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003802 userlist L1
3803 group G1 users tiger,scott
3804 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003806 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3807 user scott insecure-password elgato
3808 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003809
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003810 userlist L2
3811 group G1
3812 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003813
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003814 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3815 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3816 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003817
3818 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003819
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003820
38213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003822----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003823It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003824several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003825instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003826values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3827type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3828values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3829active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3830switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3831present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3832watch it.
3833
3834Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3835known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3836the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3837process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3838during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3839tables.
3840
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003841Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3842that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3843each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003844
3845peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003846 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003847 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3848
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003849bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3850bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003851 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3852 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3853
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003854disabled
3855 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3856 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3857 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3858
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003859default-bind [param*]
3860 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3861
3862default-server [param*]
3863 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3864
3865 Arguments:
3866 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3867 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003868 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3869 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3870 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3871 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003872
3873 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3874
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003875enabled
3876 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3877 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003878
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003879log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003880 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3881 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3882 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3883 more details.
3884
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003885peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3886peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003887 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3888 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003889 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003890 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3891 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3892 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003893 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003894
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003895 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003896 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3897
3898 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003899 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3900 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3901 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003902
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003903 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3904 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003905
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003906 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3907 "server" keyword explanation below).
3908
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003909server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3910server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003911 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003912 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003913 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3914 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3915 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003916
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003917 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3918 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3919 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3920 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3921 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003922
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003923 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003924 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003925 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003926 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3927 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3928 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003929
3930 backend mybackend
3931 mode tcp
3932 balance roundrobin
3933 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3934 stick on src
3935
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003936 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3937 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003938
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003939 Example:
3940 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003941 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3942 default-server ssl verify none
3943 server haproxy1 #local peer
3944 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3945 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003946
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003947shards <shards>
3948
3949 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3950 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3951 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3952 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3953 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003954
3955table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3957
3958 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3959 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003960 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003961 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3962 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3963 "stick-table" keyword).
3964
3965 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3966 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3967 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3968 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3969 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3970 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3971 of the stick-table name as follows:
3972
3973 peers mypeers
3974 peer A ...
3975 peer B ...
3976 table t1 ...
3977
3978 frontend fe1
3979 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3980
3981 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3982 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3983
3984 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3985 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3986 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3987 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3988 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3989 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3990 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3991
3992 peers mypeers
3993 peer A ...
3994 peer B ...
3995 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3996
3997 backend t1
3998 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3999
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004000 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01004001 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
4002 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
4003
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090040043.6. Mailers
4005------------
4006It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
4007If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
4008in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
4009
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02004010mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004011 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
4012 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
4013
4014mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
4015 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
4016
4017 Example:
4018 mailers mymailers
4019 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
4020 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
4021
4022 backend mybackend
4023 mode tcp
4024 balance roundrobin
4025
4026 email-alert mailers mymailers
4027 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4028 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4029
4030 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4031 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4032
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004033timeout mail <time>
4034 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4035 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4036 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4037 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4038
4039 Example:
4040 mailers mymailers
4041 timeout mail 20s
4042 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004043
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040443.7. Programs
4045-------------
4046In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4047master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4048managed the same way as the workers.
4049
4050During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4051sequence as a worker:
4052
4053 - the master is re-executed
4054 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4055 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4056 instance of the program
4057
4058During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4059
4060program <name>
4061 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4062 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4063 the management guide).
4064
4065command <command> [arguments*]
4066 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4067 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4068 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4069 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4070
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004071user <user name>
4072 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4073 See also "group".
4074
4075group <group name>
4076 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4077 See also "user".
4078
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004079option start-on-reload
4080no option start-on-reload
4081 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4082 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4083 program section.
4084
4085
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040863.8. HTTP-errors
4087----------------
4088
4089It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4090imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4091several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4092
4093http-errors <name>
4094 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4095 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4096
4097errorfile <code> <file>
4098 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4099
4100 Arguments :
4101 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004102 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004103 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004104
4105 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4106 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4107 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4108 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4109 before any chroot is performed.
4110
4111 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4112
4113 Example:
4114 http-errors website-1
4115 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4116 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4117 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4118
4119 http-errors website-2
4120 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4121 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4122 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4123
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020041243.9. Rings
4125----------
4126
4127It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4128servers or traces.
4129
4130ring <ringname>
4131 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4132
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004133backing-file <path>
4134 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4135 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4136 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4137 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4138 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4139 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4140 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4141
4142 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4143 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4144 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4145 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004146 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4147 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4148 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4149 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4150 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4151 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4152 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4153 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4154 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4155 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4156 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4157 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004158
4159 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4160 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4161 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4162 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4163 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4164 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4165 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4166
4167 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4168 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4169 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4170
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004171description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004172 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004173 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4174
4175format <format>
4176 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4177
4178 Arguments:
4179 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4180 one of the following :
4181
4182 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4183 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4184 designed to be used with a local log server.
4185
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004186 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4187 field is stripped. This is the default.
4188 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4189 rfc3164.
4190
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004191 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4192 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4193 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4194 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4195 is the default.
4196
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004197 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004198 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4199
4200 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4201 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4202
4203 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4204 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4205 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4206 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4207 logger consumes.
4208
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004209 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4210 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4211 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4212 with a local log server.
4213
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004214 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4215 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4216 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4217 used with a local log server.
4218
4219maxlen <length>
4220 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4221 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4222 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4223
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004224server <name> <address> [param*]
4225 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4226 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4227 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4228 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4229 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4230 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4231 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4232 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4233 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004234 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4235 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004236
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004237size <size>
4238 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4239 set to BUFSIZE.
4240
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004241timeout connect <timeout>
4242 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4243
4244 Arguments :
4245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4247 as explained at the top of this document.
4248
4249timeout server <timeout>
4250 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4251
4252 Arguments :
4253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4255 as explained at the top of this document.
4256
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004257 Example:
4258 global
4259 log ring@myring local7
4260
4261 ring myring
4262 description "My local buffer"
4263 format rfc3164
4264 maxlen 1200
4265 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004266 timeout connect 5s
4267 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004268 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004269
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042703.10. Log forwarding
4271-------------------
4272
4273It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004274HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004275
4276log-forward <name>
4277 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4278
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004279backlog <conns>
4280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4281 on connections accept.
4282
4283bind <addr> [param*]
4284 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004285 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4286 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4287 syslog protocol over TCP.
4288 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004289 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4290
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004291dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004292 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4293 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4294 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4295 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004296 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004297
4298log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004299log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004300 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4301 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4302 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004303 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004304 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4305 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4306 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004307 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004308
4309 Example:
4310 global
4311 log stderr format iso local7
4312
4313 ring myring
4314 description "My local buffer"
4315 format rfc5424
4316 maxlen 1200
4317 size 32764
4318 timeout connect 5s
4319 timeout server 10s
4320 # syslog tcp server
4321 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4322
4323 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004324 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4325 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004326 # all messages on stderr
4327 log global
4328 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4329 log ring@myring local0
4330 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4331 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4332 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4333 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4334 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004335
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004336maxconn <conns>
4337 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4338 10 is the default.
4339
4340timeout client <timeout>
4341 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4342
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +000043433.11. HTTPClient tuning
4344-----------------------
4345
4346HTTPClient is an internal HTTP library, it can be used by various subsystems,
4347for example in LUA scripts. HTTPClient is not used in the data path, in other
4348words it has nothing with HTTP traffic passing through HAProxy.
4349
4350httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
4351 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
4352 "default" resolvers section.
4353
4354 Default value is off.
4355
4356httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
4357 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
4358 to resolve.
4359
4360 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
4361 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
4362
4363 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4364 configuration error if it fails to load.
4365
4366httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
4367 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
4368 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
4369 option is "ipv6".
4370
4371httpclient.retries <number>
4372 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
4373 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
4374 in a backend.
4375
4376 Default value is 3.
4377
4378httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
4379 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
4380 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
4381 server line.
4382
4383 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4384 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
4385 will be disabled for the httpclient.
4386
4387 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4388 configuration error if it fails.
4389
4390httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
4391 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
4392 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
4393
4394 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4395 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
4396
4397 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4398 configuration error if it fails.
4399
4400httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
4401 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
4402 httpclient.
4403
4404 Arguments :
4405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4407 as explained at the top of this document.
4408
4409 The default value is 5000ms.
4410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004412----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004414Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004415 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4416 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4417 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4418 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004419
4420A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4421connections.
4422
4423A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4424to forward incoming connections.
4425
4426A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4427parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4428
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004429A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4430ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4431sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4432the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4433explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4434from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4435"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4436for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4437to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4438optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4439are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4440any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4441names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4442that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4443duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004444names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4445is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4446implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4447encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4448adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004449
4450Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4451settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4452of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4453profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4454timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004456All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4457'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4458case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4459
4460Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4461logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4462proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4463However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4464name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4465
4466Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4467and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004468bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4470modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4471arbitrary criteria.
4472
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004473In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4474a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004475the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004476
4477 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4478 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4479 between responses and new requests.
4480
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004481 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4482 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4483 client-facing connection remains open.
4484
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004485 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4486 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004487
4488The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4489frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4490following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004491weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004492
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004493 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004494
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004495 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4496 ----+-----+-----+----
4497 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4498 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004499 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4500 ----+-----+-----+----
4501 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004502
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004503It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004504only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4505within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004506as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004507content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004508and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4509possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004510
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004511There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004512first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004513processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004514second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004515protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4516is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4517new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004518to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004519process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4520already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4521HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4522evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4523one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4524
4525There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4526performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4527tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4528preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4529analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4530HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4531header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4532mitigate this drawback.
4533
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004534There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004535method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4536set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4537in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4538is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4539to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4540above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4541to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4542"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4543frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4544frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4545as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4546upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4547on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4548the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4549upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4550frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4551remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020045534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4554--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004556The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4557limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4558they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4559limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004560marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004561option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004562and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4563with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004564specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4565sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4566anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004568
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004569 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4570------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004571acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004572backlog X X X -
4573balance X - X X
4574bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004575capture cookie - X X -
4576capture request header - X X -
4577capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004578clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4579clitcpka-idle X X X -
4580clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004581compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004582cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004583declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004584default-server X - X X
4585default_backend X X X -
4586description - X X X
4587disabled X X X X
4588dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004589email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004590email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004591email-alert mailers X X X X
4592email-alert myhostname X X X X
4593email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004594enabled X X X X
4595errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004596errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004597errorloc X X X X
4598errorloc302 X X X X
4599-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4600errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004601error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004602force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004603filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004604fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004605hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004606http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004607http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004608http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004610http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004611http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004612http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004613http-check set-var X - X X
4614http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004615http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004616http-request X (!) X X X
4617http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004618http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004619http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004620id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004621ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004622load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004623log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004624log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004625log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004626log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004627max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004628max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004629maxconn X X X -
4630mode X X X X
4631monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004632monitor-uri X X X -
4633option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4634option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4635option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4636option allbackups (*) X - X X
4637option checkcache (*) X - X X
4638option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4639option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004640option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004641option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4642option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004643-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4644option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004645option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004646option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4647option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004648option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004649option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004650option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004651option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004652option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004653option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004654option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4655option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4656option httpchk X - X X
4657option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004658option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004659option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004660option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004661option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004662option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004663option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4664option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4665option logasap (*) X X X -
4666option mysql-check X - X X
4667option nolinger (*) X X X X
4668option originalto X X X X
4669option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004670option pgsql-check X - X X
4671option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004672option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004673option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004674option smtpchk X - X X
4675option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4676option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4677option splice-request (*) X X X X
4678option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004679option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004680option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4681option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4682-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004683option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004684option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4685option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4686option tcpka X X X X
4687option tcplog X X X X
4688option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004689option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004690external-check command X - X X
4691external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004692persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4693rate-limit sessions X X X -
4694redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004695-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004696retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004697retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004698server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004699server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004700server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004701source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004702srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4703srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4704srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004705stats admin - X X X
4706stats auth X X X X
4707stats enable X X X X
4708stats hide-version X X X X
4709stats http-request - X X X
4710stats realm X X X X
4711stats refresh X X X X
4712stats scope X X X X
4713stats show-desc X X X X
4714stats show-legends X X X X
4715stats show-node X X X X
4716stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004717-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4718stick match - - X X
4719stick on - - X X
4720stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004721stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004722stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004723tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004724tcp-check connect X - X X
4725tcp-check expect X - X X
4726tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004727tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004728tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004729tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004730tcp-check set-var X - X X
4731tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004732tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4733tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4734tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4735tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4736tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4737tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004738timeout check X - X X
4739timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004740timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004741timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004742timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4743timeout http-request X X X X
4744timeout queue X - X X
4745timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004746timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004747timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004748timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004749transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004750unique-id-format X X X -
4751unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004752use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004753use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004754use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004755------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4756 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4760---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761
4762This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4763
4764
4765acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4766 Declare or complete an access list.
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004768 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4769
4770 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4771 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4772 using it.
4773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004774 Example:
4775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004780
4781
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004782backlog <conns>
4783 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | no
4786 Arguments :
4787 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4788 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004789 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004790
4791 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4792 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4793 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4794 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4795 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4796 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4797 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4798 backlog parameter.
4799
4800 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4801 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4802 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4803
4804 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4805
4806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004807balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004808balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | no | yes | yes
4812 Arguments :
4813 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4814 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4815 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4816 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4817
4818 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4819 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4820 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4821 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004822 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004823 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004824 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4825 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4826 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4827 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4828 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4829 it, so that you don't worry.
4830
4831 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4832 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4833 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4834 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4835 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4836 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4837 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4838 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004840 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4841 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4842 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4843 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4844 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4845 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4846 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004847 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4848 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4849 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004850
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004851 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004852 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004853 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4854 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004855 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004856 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4857 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4858 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4859 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4860 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004861 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4862 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4863 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4864 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4865 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4866 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004867
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004868 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4869 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4870 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4871 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4872 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4873 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4874 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4875 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4876 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4877 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4878 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4879 changed using "hash-type".
4880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004881 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4882 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4883 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4884 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4885 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4886 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4887 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4888 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004889 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004890 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004891 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4892 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004893 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004894
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004895 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4896 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4897 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4898 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4899 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4900 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4901 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4902 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4903 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4904 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4905 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4906 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004907
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004908 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004909 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4910 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4911 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4912 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4913 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4914 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4915 URIs start with a leading "/".
4916
4917 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4918 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4919 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4920 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4921
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004922 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4923 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4924 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004925 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4926 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004928 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004929 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4930
4931 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004932 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4933 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004934 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4935 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4936 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4937 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004938 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004939 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4940 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004941
4942 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4943 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4944 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4945 server will receive the request.
4946
4947 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4948 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4949 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4950 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4951 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004952 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4953 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004954 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4955 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004956
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004957 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4958 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4959 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4960 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4961 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004963 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004964 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4965 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4966 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4967
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004968 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4969 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004970 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4971 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004972
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004973 random
4974 random(<draws>)
4975 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004976 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4977 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4978 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4979 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004980 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4981 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4982 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4983 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4984 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4985 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4986 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4987 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4988 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4989 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4990 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4991 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4992 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4993 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4994 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4995 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4996 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4997 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4998 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4999 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005000
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005001 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005002 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005003 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
5004 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005005 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005006 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
5007 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
5008 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005009 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005010 used instead.
5011
5012 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
5013 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
5014 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005015 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005016
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005017 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
5018 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005019 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
5020 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005022 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02005023 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
5024 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005025
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01005026 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
5027 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
5028 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005029
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005030 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05005031 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005032 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
5033 NTLM relies on.
5034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005035 Examples :
5036 balance roundrobin
5037 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005038 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01005039 balance hdr(User-Agent)
5040 balance hdr(host)
5041 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005042 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
5043 balance hash var(req.client_id)
5044 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005045
5046 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
5047 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
5048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005049 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005050 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
5051 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
5052 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005053 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005054
5055 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
5056 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
5057 defaults to 16 kB.
5058
5059 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
5060 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
5061
5062 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
5063 Round Robin.
5064
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005065 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005066 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
5067 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5068 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5069
5070 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5071
5072 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005074 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5075 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5076 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005077
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005078 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005079
5080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005081bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5082bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005083 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 no | yes | yes | no
5086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005087 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5088 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5089 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5090 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005091 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
Amaury Denoyelleb19d22e2024-02-15 18:43:44 +01005092 that for UDP, specific OS features are required when binding
5093 on multiple addresses to ensure the correct network interface
5094 and source address will be used on response. In other way,
5095 for QUIC listeners only bind on multiple addresses if running
5096 with a modern enough systems.
5097
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005098 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5099 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5100 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5101 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5102 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5103 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005104 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005105 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5106 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005107 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005108 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5109 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005110 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005111 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5112 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005113 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005114 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005115 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5116 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5117 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005118 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5119 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5120 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5121 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005122 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005123 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005124 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005125 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5126 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5127 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5128 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5129 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005130 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005131 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5132 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005133
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005134 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5135 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5136 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005137
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005138 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5139 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005140 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5141 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5142 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005143 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5144 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5145 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5146 the range.
5147
5148 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5149 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5150 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5151 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5152 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5153 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5154 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005155 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005156 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005157
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005158 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005159 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005160 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5161 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5162 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5163 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5164 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5165 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5166
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005167 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5168 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5169 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5170 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005172 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5173 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5174 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5175 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5176 in a frontend.
5177
5178 Example :
5179 listen http_proxy
5180 bind :80,:443
5181 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005182 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005183
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005184 listen http_https_proxy
5185 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005186 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005187
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005188 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5189 bind ipv6@:80
5190 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5191 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5192
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005193 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005194 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005195
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005196 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005197 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005198
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005199 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5200 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5201 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5202 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5203 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5204
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005205 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005206 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005207
5208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005209capture cookie <name> len <length>
5210 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 no | yes | yes | no
5213 Arguments :
5214 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5215 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5216 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5217 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005218 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005219
5220 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5221 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5222 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5223 right if it exceeds <length>.
5224
5225 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5226 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5227 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5228 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5229
5230 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5231 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5232 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5233
5234 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5235 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5236 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005237 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5238 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5239 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005240
5241 Example:
5242 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5243
5244 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005245 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005246
5247
5248capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005249 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 no | yes | yes | no
5252 Arguments :
5253 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005254 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005255 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5256 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5257 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5258
5259 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5260 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5261 it exceeds <length>.
5262
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005263 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005264 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5265 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005266 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5267 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5268 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5269 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005270 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005271 environments to find where the request came from.
5272
5273 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5274 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5275 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5276 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005277
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005278 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5279 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5280 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5281 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5282 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005283
5284 Example:
5285 capture request header Host len 15
5286 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005287 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005289 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005290 about logging.
5291
5292
5293capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005294 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 no | yes | yes | no
5297 Arguments :
5298 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005299 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005300 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5301 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5302 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5303
5304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5305 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5306 it exceeds <length>.
5307
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005308 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005309 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5310 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5311 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005312 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5313 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5314 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5315 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005316
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005317 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5318 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5319 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5320 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5321 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005322
5323 Example:
5324 capture response header Content-length len 9
5325 capture response header Location len 15
5326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005327 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005328 about logging.
5329
5330
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005331clitcpka-cnt <count>
5332 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5333 the connection on the client side.
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | yes | yes | no
5336 Arguments :
5337 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5338
5339 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5340 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005341 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5342 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005343
5344 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5345
5346
5347clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5348 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5349 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5350 client side.
5351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5352 yes | yes | yes | no
5353 Arguments :
5354 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5355 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5356 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5357 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5358
5359 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5360 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005361 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5362 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005363
5364 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5365
5366
5367clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5368 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | yes | yes | no
5371 Arguments :
5372 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5373 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5374 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5375 document.
5376
5377 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5378 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005379 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5380 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005381
5382 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5383
5384
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005385compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005386compression algo-req <algorithm>
5387compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005388compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005389 Enable HTTP compression.
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | yes | yes | yes
5392 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005393 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5394 responses (legacy keyword)
5395 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5396 provided).
5397 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5398 responses.
5399 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5400 responses (legacy keyword).
5401 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5402 requests.
5403 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5404 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005405
5406 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005407 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5408 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5409 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005410
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005411 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005412 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005413
5414 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5415 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5416 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5417 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5418 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005419 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005420
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005421 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5422 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5423 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5424 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5425 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5426 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5427 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005428 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005429
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005430 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005431 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005432 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005433 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005434 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005435 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005436 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005437
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005438 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005439 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5440 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005441 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005442 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005443 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5444 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5445 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5446 "multipart"
5447 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5448 header
5449 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5450 and later
5451 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5452 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005453 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005454
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005455 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005456
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005457 Examples :
5458 compression algo gzip
5459 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005460
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005461 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005462
5463compression offload
5464 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 no | yes | yes | yes
5467
5468 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5469 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5470 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5471 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5472 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5473 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5474 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5475 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5476 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5477 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5478 then be used for such scenarios.
5479
5480 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5481 option is ignored.
5482
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005483 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5484
5485compression direction <direction>
5486 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5487 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5488 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5489 The default value is "response".
5490
5491 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005492
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005493cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005494 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5495 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005496 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005497 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | no | yes | yes
5500 Arguments :
5501 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5502 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5503 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5504 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5505 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5506 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005508 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5509 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5510
5511 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005512 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005513 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5514 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5515 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5516 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005517 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5518 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005519 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005520 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5521 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005522
5523 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005524 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005525
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005526 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005527 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005528 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005529 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005530 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5531 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5532 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5533 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5534 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5535 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5536 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005537
5538 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5539 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5540 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5541 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5542 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5543 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5544 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5545 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5546 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005547 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005548 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5549 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5550 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005551
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005552 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5553 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5554 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005555 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5556 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5557 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5558 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005559 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5560 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5561 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005562
5563 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5564 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5565 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5566 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5567 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5568 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5569 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5570 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5571 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5572
5573 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5574 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5575 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5576 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5577 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5578 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5579 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5580 persistence cookie in the cache.
5581 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5582
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005583 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5584 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005585 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005586 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5587 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005588 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005589 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5590 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5591 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5592 they logout.
5593
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005594 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005595 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5596 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5597 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5598
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005599 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005600 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5601 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5602 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5603 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5604 this attribute.
5605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005606 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005607 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005608 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5609 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5610 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5611 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5612 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5613 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005614
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005615 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5616 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5617 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5618 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5619 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5620 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5621 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5622 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005623 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005624 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5625 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5626 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5627 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5628 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5629 the site.
5630
5631 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5632 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5633 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5634 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5635 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5636 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5637 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5638 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5639 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5640 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5641 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5642 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5643 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005644 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005645 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5646 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5647
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005648 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5649 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5650 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5651 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5652 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5653 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5654
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005655 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005656 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5657 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5658 repeated.
5659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005660 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5661 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5662 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5663 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005665 Examples :
5666 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5667 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5668 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005669 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005670
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005671 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005672
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005673
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005674declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5675 Declares a capture slot.
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 no | yes | yes | no
5678 Arguments:
5679 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5680
5681 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5682 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5683 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5684 for use in the response.
5685
5686 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005687 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005688 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5689
5690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005691default-server [param*]
5692 Change default options for a server in a backend
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 yes | no | yes | yes
5695 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005696 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5697 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5698 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5699 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005700
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005701 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005702 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5703
5704 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005705
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005707default_backend <backend>
5708 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | yes | yes | no
5711 Arguments :
5712 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5713
5714 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5715 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5716 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5717 will catch all undetermined requests.
5718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005719 Example :
5720
5721 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5722 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5723 default_backend dynamic
5724
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005725 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005727
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005728description <string>
5729 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 no | yes | yes | yes
5732 Arguments : string
5733
5734 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5735 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5736 it describes.
5737 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5738
5739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005740disabled
5741 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | yes | yes | yes
5744 Arguments : none
5745
5746 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5747 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5748 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5749 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5750 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5751 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5752 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5753
5754 See also : "enabled"
5755
5756
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005757dispatch <address>:<port>
5758 Set a default server address
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005762
5763 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5764 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5765 during start-up.
5766
5767 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5768 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5769 possible with normal servers.
5770
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005771 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005772 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5773 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5774 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5775 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5776
5777 See also : "server"
5778
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005779
5780dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5781 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | no | yes | yes
5784 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5785
5786 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005788 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5789 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005790 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005791 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005793enabled
5794 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | yes | yes | yes
5797 Arguments : none
5798
5799 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5800 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5801
5802 See also : "disabled"
5803
5804
5805errorfile <code> <file>
5806 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | yes | yes | yes
5809 Arguments :
5810 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005811 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005812 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813
5814 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005815 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005816 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005817 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5818 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005819
5820 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5821 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5822 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5823
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005824 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5825
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005826 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5827 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5828 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5829 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5830 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5831 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5832 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5833 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5834 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005836 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5837 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5838 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005839 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005840 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5841
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005842 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005843
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005844 Example :
5845 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005846 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005847 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5848 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005850
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005851errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5852 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5853 section.
5854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | yes | yes | yes
5856 Arguments :
5857 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5858
5859 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005860 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005861 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5862 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005863
5864 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5865 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5866 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5867 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5868 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005869 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005870 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5871
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005872 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5873 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005874
5875 Example :
5876 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005877 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005878
5879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005880errorloc <code> <url>
5881errorloc302 <code> <url>
5882 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 yes | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments :
5886 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005887 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005888 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005889
5890 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5891 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5892 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5893 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005894 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005895
5896 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5897 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5898 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5899
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005900 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5901
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005902 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5903 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5904 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5905 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005906 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005907 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5908 request.
5909
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005910 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005911
5912
5913errorloc303 <code> <url>
5914 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | yes | yes | yes
5917 Arguments :
5918 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005919 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005920 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005921
5922 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5923 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5924 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5925 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005926 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927
5928 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5929 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5930 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5931
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005932 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5933
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005934 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5935 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5936 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5937 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005938 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005939
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005940 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005941
5942
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005943email-alert from <emailaddr>
5944 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005945 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948
5949 Arguments :
5950
5951 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5952
5953 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5954 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5955
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005956 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005957 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5958 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005959
5960
5961email-alert level <level>
5962 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5963 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | yes | yes | yes
5966
5967 Arguments :
5968
5969 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5970 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5971 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5972
5973 By default level is alert
5974
5975 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5976 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5977 for the proxy.
5978
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005979 Alerts are sent when :
5980
5981 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5982 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5983 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5984 is notice or lower
5985 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5986 and a health check status update occurs
5987
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005988 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5989 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005990 section 3.6 about mailers.
5991
5992
5993email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5994 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | yes | yes | yes
5997
5998 Arguments :
5999
6000 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
6001
6002 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
6003 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6004
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006005 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
6006 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006007
6008
6009email-alert myhostname <hostname>
6010 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
6011 mailers.
6012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | yes | yes | yes
6014
6015 Arguments :
6016
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01006017 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006018
6019 By default the systems hostname is used.
6020
6021 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
6022 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
6023 for the proxy.
6024
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006025 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
6026 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006027
6028
6029email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006030 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006031 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
6032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | yes | yes | yes
6034
6035 Arguments :
6036
6037 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
6038
6039 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
6040 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6041
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006042 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006043 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
6044
6045
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006046error-log-format <string>
6047 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
6048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | yes | yes | no
6050
6051 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
6052 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
6053 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
6054 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01006055 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
6056
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006057 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006058 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
6059 format string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006060
6061 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
6062 directives.
6063
6064
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006065force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6066 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
6067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006068 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006069
6070 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6071 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6072 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6073 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6074 marked down for maintenance operations.
6075
6076 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6077 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6078 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6079 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6080 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6081 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6082 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6083 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6084 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6085
6086 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6087 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6088 is used.
6089
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006090 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006091 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006092
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006093
6094filter <name> [param*]
6095 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 no | yes | yes | yes
6098 Arguments :
6099 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6100 referenced in section 9.
6101
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006102 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006103 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006104 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6105 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006106
6107 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6108 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6109
6110 Example:
6111 listen
6112 bind *:80
6113
6114 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6115 filter compression
6116 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6117
6118 compression algo gzip
6119 compression offload
6120
6121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6122
6123 See also : section 9.
6124
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006126fullconn <conns>
6127 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | no | yes | yes
6130 Arguments :
6131 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6132 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6133
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006134 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006135 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006136 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006137 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6138 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6139 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6140 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6141 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006142 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006144 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006145 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006146 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6147 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6148 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006150 Example :
6151 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6152 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6153 # connections.
6154 backend dynamic
6155 fullconn 10000
6156 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6157 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6158
6159 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6160
6161
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006162hash-balance-factor <factor>
6163 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 yes | no | no | yes
6166 Arguments :
6167 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6168 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006169 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006170
6171 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6172 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6173 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6174 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6175 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6176 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6177 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6178
6179 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6180 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6181 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6182 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6183 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6184
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006185 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6186 consistent hashing mechanism.
6187
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006188 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6189
6190
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006191hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006192 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | no | yes | yes
6195 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006196 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6197 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006198
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006199 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6200 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6201 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6202 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6203 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6204 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6205 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6206 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6207 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6208 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006209
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006210 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6211 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6212 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6213 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6214 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6215 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6216 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6217 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6218 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6219 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6220 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6221 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6222 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006223 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6224 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006225
6226 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006228 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006229 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6230 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6231 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006232 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6233 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6234 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006235
6236 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6237 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006238 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6239 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6240 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6241 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006243 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006244 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6245 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6246 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6247 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6248 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6249 parameter.
6250
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006251 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6252 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6253 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6254 used on strings.
6255
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006256 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6257
6258 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6259 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6260 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6261 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6262 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6263 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6264 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6265 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6266 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6267 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6268 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6269 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006270
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006271 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6272 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6273 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006274
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006275 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006276
6277
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006278http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6279 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6280 ones).
6281
6282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006283 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006284
6285 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6286 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6287 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6289 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6290 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6291
6292 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6293 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6294 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6295
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006296 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6297 supported:
6298 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6299 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006300 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006301 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006302 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006303 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006304 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6305 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006306 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006307 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6308 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6309 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6310 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6311 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006312 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006313 - set-log-level <level>
6314 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006315 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006316 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6317 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006318 - strict-mode { on | off }
6319 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6320
6321 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006322
6323 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6324 instance.
6325
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006326 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6327 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6328 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6329 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6330 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6331 a defaults section defining such rules.
6332
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006333 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6334 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6335 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6336
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006337 Example:
6338 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6339 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6340 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6341
6342http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6343
6344 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006345 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6346 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006347
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006348http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6351 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6352
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006353http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6354
6355 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6356 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6357 complete description.
6358
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006359http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6362 del-acl" for a complete description.
6363
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006364http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006365
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006366 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6367 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006368
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006369http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6370
6371 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6372 del-map" for a complete description.
6373
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006374http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6376
6377 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6378
6379 Example:
6380 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6381
6382 # applied to:
6383 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6384
6385 # outputs:
6386 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6387
6388 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6389
6390http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6391 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6392
6393 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6394
6395 Example:
6396 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6397
6398 # applied to:
6399 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6400
6401 # outputs:
6402 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6403
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006404http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6406
6407 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6408 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6409 a complete description.
6410
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006411http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6414
6415 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6416 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6417 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6418 description.
6419
6420http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6422http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424
6425 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6426 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006427 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006428
6429http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6432 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6433
6434http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6435
6436 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6437 set-map" for a complete description.
6438
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006439http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006441 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6442 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6443 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6444 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006445
6446http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6448
6449 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006450 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006451 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006452
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006453http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006455
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006456 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6457 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6458 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006459
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006460http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006461
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006462 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6463 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006464
6465http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006467 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6468 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006469
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006470
6471http-check comment <string>
6472 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6473 it fails.
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6475 yes | no | yes | yes
6476
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006477 Arguments :
6478 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6479 rule fails.
6480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006481 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6482 user-friendly error reporting.
6483
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006484 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006485 "http-check expect".
6486
6487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006488http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6489 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006490 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006491 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | no | yes | yes
6494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006495 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006496 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6497
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006498 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006499 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006500
6501 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6502 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6503 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6504 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6505
6506 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6507
6508 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6509
6510 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6511
6512 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6513
6514 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6515
6516 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6517 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6518 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6519 is used.
6520
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006521 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6522 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6523 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6524 haproxy -vv.
6525
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006526 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006528 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6529 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6530 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6531 different ports or with different servers.
6532
6533 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6534 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6535 the port with a "http-check connect".
6536
6537 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6538 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6539 do.
6540
6541 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6542 unset-var or comment rules.
6543
6544 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006545 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6546 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6547 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6548 option httpchk
6549
6550 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006551 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006552 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006553 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006554 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006555 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006556
6557 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6558
6559 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006560
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006562http-check disable-on-404
6563 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006565 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006566 Arguments : none
6567
6568 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6569 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6570 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6571 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6572 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6573 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6574 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6575 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006576 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6577 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006578 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6579 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6580 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006581
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006582 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006583
6584
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006585http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006586 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6587 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6588 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006589 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006591 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006592
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006593 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006594 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6595
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006596 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6597 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6598 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6599 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6600 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6601 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6602 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6603 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6604 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6605 result is always conclusive.
6606
6607 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6608 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6609 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006610 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6611 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006612 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6613 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006614 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6615 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6616 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006617
6618 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6619 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006620 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6621 supported :
6622 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6623 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006624 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6625 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6626 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6627 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6628 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006629
6630 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6631 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006632 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6633 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6634 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6635 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006636 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6637
6638 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6639 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6640 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6641 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6642
6643 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6644 informational message reported in logs if an error
6645 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6646 log-format string.
6647
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006648 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006649 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6650 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006651 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6652 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6653 details on the supported keywords.
6654
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006655 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6656 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6657 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6658 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006659
6660 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6661 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6662 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6663 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6664 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6665
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006666 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6667 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6668 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6669 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6670 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6671 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6672 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006673
6674 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006675 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006676 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6677 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6678 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6679 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6680
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006681 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6682 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006683 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6684 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6685 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6686 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6687 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6688 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6689 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6690 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006691 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6692 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6693 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6694 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6695 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6696 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6697 insensitive on the header names.
6698
6699 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6700 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6701 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6702 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6703 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6704 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006705
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006706 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006707 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006708 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6709 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6710 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6711 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6712 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006713 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006714 trace).
6715
6716 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006717 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006718 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6719 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6720 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6721 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6722 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006723 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006724
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006725 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6726 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6727 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6728 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6729 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6730 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6731
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006732 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006733 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006734 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6735 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6736 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6737 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6738 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6739 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006741 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6742 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6743 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6744 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6745 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006746
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006747 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6748 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6749
6750 Examples :
6751 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006752 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006753
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006754 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6755 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6756
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006757 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006758 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006759
6760 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006761 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006762
6763 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006764 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006765
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006766 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006767 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006768
6769
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006770http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006771 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6772 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006773 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6774 health checks.
6775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6776 yes | no | yes | yes
6777 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006778 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6779
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006780 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6781 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6782 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6783 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6784 to invent non-standard ones.
6785
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006786 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6787 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6788 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6789 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6790
6791 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6792 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6793 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6794 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006795
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006796 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006797 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006798 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006799 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6800 to add it.
6801
6802 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6803 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6804 to the log-format rules.
6805
6806 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6807 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6808 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006809
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006810 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6811 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6812 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6813 request.
6814
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006815 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6816 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6817 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006818 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6819 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6820 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6821 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006822 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006823
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006824 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006825 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6826 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006827
6828 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6829 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6830 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6831 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6832 configured request authority.
6833
6834 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6835 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006836
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006837 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006838
6839
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006840http-check send-state
6841 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | no | yes | yes
6844 Arguments : none
6845
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006846 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006847 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006848 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6849 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6850 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006851
6852 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6853 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6854 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6855 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6856 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006857 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6858 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6859 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6860
6861 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6862 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6863 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6864
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006865 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6866 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6867 checked in multiple backends.
6868
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006869 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006870 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6871
6872 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6873 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6874 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6875 one fails.
6876
6877 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6878 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6879 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6880
6881 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6882 server's queue.
6883
6884 Example of a header received by the application server :
6885 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6886 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6887
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006888 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6889 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006890
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006891
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006892http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6893http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006894 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | no | yes | yes
6897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006898 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006899 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6900 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6901 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6902 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6903 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6905 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6906 and '-'.
6907
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006908 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6909 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006910 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006911 conditions.
6912
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006913 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6914
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006915 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006916 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006917
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006918 Examples :
6919 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006920 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006921
6922
6923http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006924 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6926 yes | no | yes | yes
6927
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006928 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006929 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6930 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6931 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6932 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6933 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6934 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6935 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6936 and '-'.
6937
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006938 Examples :
6939 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006941
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006942http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6943 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6944 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6945 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6946 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | yes | yes | yes
6949 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006950 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006951 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006952 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006953 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006954
6955 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6956 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6957 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6958 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6959
6960 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6961 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6962 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6963 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6964
6965 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6966 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6967 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6968 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6969 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6970 chroot is performed.
6971
6972 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6973 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6974 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6975 considered.
6976
6977 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6978 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6979 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6980 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6981 considered as a raw string.
6982
6983 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6984 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6985 "content-type".
6986
6987 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6988 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6989 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6990 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6991 evaluated as a log-format string.
6992
6993 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6994 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6995 argument to "content-type".
6996
6997 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6998 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6999 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
7000 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
7001
7002 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
7003 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
7004 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
7005 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
7006 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
7007 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
7008 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
7009 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
7010
7011 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
7012 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
7013 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
7014
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01007015 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
7016 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
7017 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
7018 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
7019 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
7020
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02007021 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
7022 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
7023
7024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007025http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007026 Access control for Layer 7 requests
7027
7028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007029 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007030
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007031 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7032 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7033 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7034 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7035 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007036
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007037 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7038 supported:
7039 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7040 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7041 - allow
7042 - auth [realm <realm>]
7043 - cache-use <name>
7044 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7045 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7046 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7047 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7048 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7049 - disable-l7-retry
7050 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7051 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
7052 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
7053 - redirect <rule>
7054 - reject
7055 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7056 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7057 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7058 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7059 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7060 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007061 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007062 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7063 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7064 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7065 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7066 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007067 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007068 - set-dst <expr>
7069 - set-dst-port <expr>
7070 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7071 - set-log-level <level>
7072 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7073 - set-mark <mark>
7074 - set-method <fmt>
7075 - set-nice <nice>
7076 - set-path <fmt>
7077 - set-pathq <fmt>
7078 - set-priority-class <expr>
7079 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7080 - set-query <fmt>
7081 - set-src <expr>
7082 - set-src-port <expr>
7083 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7084 - set-tos <tos>
7085 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007086 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7087 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007088 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007089 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007090 - strict-mode { on | off }
7091 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7092 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7093 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7094 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7095 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7096 - use-service <service-name>
7097 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7098 - wait-for-handshake
7099 - cache-use <name>
7100
7101 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007103 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007104
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007105 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7106 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7107 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7108 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7109 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7110 a defaults section defining such rules.
7111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007112 Example:
7113 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7114 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7115 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007117 http-request allow if nagios
7118 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7119 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7120 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007122 Example:
7123 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7124 acl add path /addacl
7125 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007129 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7130 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007132 Example:
7133 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7134 acl setmap path /setmap
7135 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007137 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007139 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7140 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007142 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7143 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007145http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007147 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7148 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7149 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7150 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7151 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7152 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7153 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7154 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007156http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007158 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7159 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7160 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7161 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7162 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7163 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7164 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7165 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007167http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007169 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007170 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007172http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007174 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7175 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7176 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7177 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7178 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007179
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007180 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7181 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7182 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7183 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7184 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7185 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7186 instead.
7187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007188 Example:
7189 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7190 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007191
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007192http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007193
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007194 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007196http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007199 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7200 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7201 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7202 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7203 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7204 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7205 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7206 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7207 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007209 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7210 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7211 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007212 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7213
7214 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7215 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7216 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7217 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007219http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007221 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7222 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7223 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7224 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7225 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7226 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007227
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007228http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007229
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007230 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7231 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7232 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7233 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7234 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007236http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007238 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7239 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7240 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7241 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7242 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7243 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007244
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007245http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7246http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7247 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7248 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7249 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007251
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007252 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7253 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7254 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007255 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007256 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7257 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7258 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007259 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007260 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007261
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007262http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7264 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7265 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007267http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007269
7270 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7271 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7272 pointed by <resolvers>.
7273 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7274 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7275 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7276 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7277 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7278 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7279 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7280 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7281 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7282 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007283 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7284 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007285
7286 Example:
7287 resolvers mydns
7288 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7289 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7290 timeout retry 1s
7291 hold valid 10s
7292 hold nx 3s
7293 hold other 3s
7294 hold obsolete 0s
7295 accepted_payload_size 8192
7296
7297 frontend fe
7298 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007299 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007300 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7301
7302 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7303 # which mean DNS resolution error
7304 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7305
7306 default_backend be
7307
7308 backend b_503
7309 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7310 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7311 # 503 error page to end users
7312
7313 backend be
7314 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7315 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7316 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7317 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7318 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7319
7320 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7321 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7322
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007323http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7326 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7327 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7328 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007329 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7330 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007331
7332 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7333
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007334http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007335http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007336http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007337http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007338http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007339http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007340http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007341http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007343
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007344 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7345
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007346 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007347 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7348 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7349 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7350 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007351
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007352 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7353 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7354 the supported backend.
7355
7356 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7357 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7358 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7359 number of segments in the path.
7360
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007361 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7362 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7363 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7364 when improperly combined.
7365
7366 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7367 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7368 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7369 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7370 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7371
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007372 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007373
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007374 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7375
7376 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7377 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7378
7379 Example:
7380 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7381
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007382 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7383
7384 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7385 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7386
7387 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7388 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7389
7390 Example:
7391 - /#foo -> /
7392
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007393 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7394 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007395
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007396 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7397 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7398
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007399 Example:
7400 - /. -> /
7401 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7402 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7403 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007404
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007405 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7406 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7407
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007408 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007409 their preceding segment.
7410
7411 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7412 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7413
7414 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7415 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007416
7417 Example:
7418 - /foo/../ -> /
7419 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7420 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7421 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007422 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007423 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007424 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007425
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007426 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7427 removed as well:
7428
7429 Example:
7430 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7431 - /bar/../../ -> /
7432
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007433 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7434 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007435
7436 Example:
7437 - // -> /
7438 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7439
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007440 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7441 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7442
7443 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7444 ".", "_", and "~".
7445
7446 Example:
7447 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7448 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7449 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7450 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7451
7452 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7453 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7454
7455 Example:
7456 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7457 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7458
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007459 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007460 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007461
7462 Example:
7463 - /%6f -> /%6F
7464 - /%zz -> /%zz
7465
7466 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7467 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7468
7469 Example:
7470 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7471
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007472 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007473 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7474 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7475
7476 Example:
7477 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7478 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7479 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007481http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007483 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7484 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7485 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7486 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7487 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007489http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007491 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7492 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7493 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7494 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007496http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007498
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007499 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007500 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7501 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7502 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7503 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7504 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007505
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007506 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7507 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7508 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7509 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7510 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007512 Example:
7513 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7514
7515 # applied to:
7516 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7517
7518 # outputs:
7519 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7520
7521 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007522
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007523 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7524
7525 # applied to:
7526 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007528 # outputs:
7529 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007530
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007531http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7532 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7533
7534 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7535 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007536 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7537 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7538 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007539
7540 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7541 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7542 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7543
7544 Example:
7545 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7546 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7547
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007548 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7549 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7550 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7551 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7552
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007553http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555
7556 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7557 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7558 query-string are replaced.
7559
7560 Example:
7561 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7562 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7563
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007564http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7565 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7566
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007567 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7568 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7569 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7570 against.
7571
7572 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7573 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7574 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007575
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007576 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7577 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7578 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7579 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7580 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7581 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7582 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7583 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7584 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007585 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7586 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007587
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007588 Example:
7589 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7590 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007591
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007592 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7593 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007595http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007597
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007598 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7599 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7600 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7601 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007603 Example:
7604 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007606 # applied to:
7607 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007609 # outputs:
7610 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007611
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007612http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7613 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7614 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007615 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7617
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007618 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007619 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7620 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007621 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007622 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007623 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007624 are followed to create the response :
7625
7626 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7627 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7628 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7629 ignored.
7630
7631 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7632 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007633 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007634 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7635 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007636
7637 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7638 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7639 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007640 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007641 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007642
7643 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7644 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7645 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007646 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007647 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007648 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007649
7650 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7651 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7652 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7653 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7654 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7655 as a raw content.
7656
7657 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7658 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7659 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7660 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7661 considered as a raw string.
7662
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007663 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007664 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7665 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7666 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7667
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007668 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7669 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007670 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007671
7672 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7673
7674 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007675 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007676 if { path /ping }
7677
7678 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7679 if { path /favicon.ico }
7680
7681 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7682 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7683 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7684
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007685http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7686 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7687
7688 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7689 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7690 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7691 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7692 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7693 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7694 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7695 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7696 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7697
7698 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7699 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7700 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7701 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7702 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7703 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7704
7705 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7706 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7707 uploaded bytes, etc).
7708
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007709http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7710
7711 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7712 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7713 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7714 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7715 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7716 at this index.
7717 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7718 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007720http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7721http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007723 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7724 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7725 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007726
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007727http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7728 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7729 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7730 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7731 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7732 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7733 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7734 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7735 at this index.
7736 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7737 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7738
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007739http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7740 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007741
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007742 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7743 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7744 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7745 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007747http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7749
7750 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7751 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7752 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7753 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7754 agent name must be used.
7755
7756 Arguments:
7757 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7758
7759 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7760 configuration.
7761
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007762http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7763 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007764
7765 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7766 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7767 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7768 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7769 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7770 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7771 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7772 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7773
7774 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7775 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7776 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7777
7778 Arguments:
7779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7780 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7781 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7782 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7783
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007784 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7785 bytes.
7786
7787 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7788 milliseconds.
7789
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007790 Example:
7791 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7792 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7793
7794 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007796http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007798 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7799 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7800 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7801 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7802 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007804 Arguments:
7805 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7806 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007808 Example:
7809 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7810 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007812 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7813 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007815http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007817 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7818 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7819 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007821 Arguments:
7822 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7823 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007825 Example:
7826 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7827 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007829 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7830 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7831 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007833http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007835 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7836 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7837 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7838 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7839 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007841 Example:
7842 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7843 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7844 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7845 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7846 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7847 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7848 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7849 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007852http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007854 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7855 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7856 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7857 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7858 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007860http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007863 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7864 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7865 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7866 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7867 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7868 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7869 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7870 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7871 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007873http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007874
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007875 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7876 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7877 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7878 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7879 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7880 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7881 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007882 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7883 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007885http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007887 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7888 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7889 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007891http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007893 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7894 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7895 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7896 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7897 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7898 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7899 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7900 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007902http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007904 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7905 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7906 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7907 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7908 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7909 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007911 Example :
7912 # prepend the host name before the path
7913 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007914
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007915http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7916
7917 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7918 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7919 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007921http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007923 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7924 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7925 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7926 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7927 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007929http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007931 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7932 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7933 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7934 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7935 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7936 values have higher priority.
7937 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7938 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7939 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7940 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7941 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007943http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007945 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7946 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7947 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7948 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7949 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7950 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7951 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007953 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007954
7955 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007956 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7957 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007959http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7960 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7961 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7962 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007963 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7964 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007965
7966 Arguments :
7967 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7968 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007969
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007970 See also "option forwardfor".
7971
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007972 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007973 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7974 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7975
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007976 # After the masking this will track connections
7977 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7978 http-request track-sc0 src
7979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007980 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7981 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7982
7983http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7984
7985 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7986 expression.
7987
7988 Arguments:
7989 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7990 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007991
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007992 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007993 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7994 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7995
7996 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7997 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7998 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7999
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008000http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8002
8003 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
8004 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
8005 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
8006 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
8007 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
8008
8009 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
8010 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
8011 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
8012 results.
8013
8014 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008015 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
8016 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008018http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8019
8020 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
8021 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
8022 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
8023 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
8024 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
8025 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
8026 information from the request.
8027
8028 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
8029
8030http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8031
8032 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
8033 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01008034 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
8035 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
8036 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
8037 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
8038 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008039 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
8040
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008041http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8042http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008043
8044 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
8045 inline.
8046
8047 Arguments:
8048 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
8049 scope. The scopes allowed are:
8050 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
8051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
8053 (request and response)
8054 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
8055 processing
8056 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8057 processing
8058 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8059 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8060 and '_'.
8061
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008062 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
8063 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05008064 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008065 conditions.
8066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8068 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008069
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008070 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8071 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8072
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008073 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008074 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008075 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8076
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008077http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008078
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008079 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8080 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8081 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8082 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8083 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8084
8085 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8086 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8087 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8088 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8089 session tables.
8090
8091 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8092 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8093 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8094 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8095 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8096 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8097 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008098
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008099http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008100
8101 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8102 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8103 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8104 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8105 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008106 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008107 processing.
8108
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008109 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008110 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8111 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8112 rules evaluation.
8113
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008114http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8115http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8116 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8117 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8118 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8119 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008120
8121 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8122 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8123 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008124 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8125 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8126 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8127 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8128 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8129 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008130 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008131 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8132 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8133 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008134 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008135 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8136 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8137 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8138 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8139 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008140
8141http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8142http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8143http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8144
8145 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8146 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008147 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8148 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8149 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8150 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008151 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8152 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8153 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8154 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8155 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8156 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8157 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8158
8159 Arguments :
8160 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8161 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8162 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8163 select which table entry to update the counters.
8164
8165 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8166 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8167 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8168 that table until the session ends.
8169
8170 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8171 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8172 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8173 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8174 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8175 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8176 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8177 useful information.
8178
8179 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8180 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8181 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8182 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8183 checks that make use of it.
8184
8185http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8186
8187 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008188
8189 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008190 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008191
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008192http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8193
8194 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8195 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8196 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8197 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8198 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8199 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8200
8201 Arguments :
8202 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8203
8204 Example:
8205 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8206
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008207http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8209
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008210 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
8211 following conditions occurs:
8212 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
8213 normally.
8214 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
8215 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
8216 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
8217 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
8218 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
8219 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
8220 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
8221 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
8222 not yet been recieved.
8223
8224 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008225
8226 Arguments :
8227
8228 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8229 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8230
8231 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008232 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008233 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008234
8235 Example:
8236 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8237
8238 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008240http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008242 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8243 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8244 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008245
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008247http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008248 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8249
8250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008251 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008252
8253 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8254 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8255 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8256 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8257 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8258 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8259
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008260 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8261 supported:
8262 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8263 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8264 - allow
8265 - cache-store <name>
8266 - capture <sample> id <id>
8267 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8268 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8269 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8270 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8271 - redirect <rule>
8272 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8273 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8274 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008275 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008276 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8277 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8278 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8279 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8280 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8281 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008282 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008283 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8284 - set-log-level <level>
8285 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8286 - set-mark <mark>
8287 - set-nice <nice>
8288 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8289 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008290 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8291 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008292 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008293 - strict-mode { on | off }
8294 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8295 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8296 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8297 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8298 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8299
8300 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008302 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008303
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008304 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8305 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8306 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8307 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8308 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8309 a defaults section defining such rules.
8310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008311 Example:
8312 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008314 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008316 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8317 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008319 Example:
8320 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008322 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008324 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8325 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008327 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8328 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008330http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008331
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008332 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8333 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008335http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008337 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008338 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8339 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008341http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8344 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008345
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008346http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008347
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008348 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008350http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008352 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8353 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8354 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8355 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8356 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8357 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8358 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008360 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8361 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8362 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8363 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8364 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008365
8366 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8367 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8368 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8369 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008370
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008371http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008373 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8374 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008375
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008376http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008378 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8379 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008380
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008381http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008382
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008383 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8384 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008385
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008386http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8387http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8388 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8389 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8390 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8391 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008392
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008393 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8394 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8395 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008396 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008397 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8398 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8399 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008400 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008401 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008403http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008405 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8406 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8407 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8408 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8409 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8410 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008412http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8413 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008415 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8416 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008418 Example:
8419 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008421 # applied to:
8422 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008424 # outputs:
8425 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008427 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008429http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8430 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008431
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008432 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008433 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008435 Example:
8436 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008438 # applied to:
8439 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008441 # outputs:
8442 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008443
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008444http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8445 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8446 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008447 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008448 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008450 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8451 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8452 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008453
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008454http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8455 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8456
8457 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8458 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8459 a complete description.
8460
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008461http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008462http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8463http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008465 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8466 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8467 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8468 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008469
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008470http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008472http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008474
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008475 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8476 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008477 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008478
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008479http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008482 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8483 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008484
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008485http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8486 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008487
8488 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8489 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8490 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008492http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008493
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008494 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8495 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8496 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8497 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008498
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008499http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8500
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008501 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8502 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008503
8504http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8505
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008506 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8507 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008508
8509http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8510
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008511 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8512 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8513 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008514
8515http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8516
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008517 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8518 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008519
8520http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8522
8523 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8524 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8525 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8526 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008527
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008528 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008529 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8530 http-response set-status 431
8531 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8532 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008533
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008534http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008536 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008537 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8538 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008539
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008540http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8541http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008542
8543 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008544 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8545 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008546
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008547http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008548
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008549 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8550 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008551 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8552 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008553
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008554http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008555
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008556 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8557 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008558
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008559http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8560http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8561http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008562
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008563 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8564 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8565 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008566
8567http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8568
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008569 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008570 about <var-name>.
8571
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008572http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8574
8575 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008576 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8577 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008578
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008579
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008580http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8581 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8582
8583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 yes | no | yes | yes
8585
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008586 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008587 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8588 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8589 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008590
8591 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8592
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008593 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8594 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8595 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8596 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8597 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8598 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8599 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008600 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008601 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8602 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008603
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008604 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8605 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8606 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8607 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8608 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8609 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8610 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008611 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8612 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8613 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8614 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8615 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8616 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008617
8618 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8619 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8620 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8621 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8622 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8623 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8624 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8625 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008626 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008627 downsides of rare connection failures.
8628
8629 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8630 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8631 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8632 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8633 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8634 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008636 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8637 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8638 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8639 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8640 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8641
8642 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008643 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8644 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8645 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8646 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008647
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008648 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
Amaury Denoyelleab6b0742024-03-20 09:25:03 +01008649 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private if possible and never shared.
8650 This won't be the case however when using a protocol with multiplexing
8651 abilities and using reuse mode level value greater than the default "safe"
8652 strategy as in this case nothing prevents the connection from being already
8653 shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008654
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008655 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008656
8657 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8658 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8659 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8660
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008661 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8662 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8663 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8664 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8665 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8666 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8667 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8668 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8669 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8670 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8671 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8672
8673 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8674 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8675 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8676 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8677 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8678
8679 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8680 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008681
8682
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008683http-send-name-header [<header>]
8684 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8686 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008687 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008688 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8689
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008690 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8691 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8692 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8693 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8694 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8695 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8696 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8697 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8698 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8699 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8700 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8701 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8702 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8703 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8704 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8705 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008706
8707 See also : "server"
8708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008709id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008710 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8712 no | yes | yes | yes
8713 Arguments : none
8714
8715 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8716 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8717 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008718
8719
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008720ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8721 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008723 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008724
8725 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8726 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8727 and running).
8728
8729 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8730 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8731 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008732 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008733 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8734
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008735 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8736 "unless" condition is met.
8737
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008738 Example:
8739 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8740 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8741 ignore-persist if url_static
8742
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008743 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8744
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008745load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8746 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8748 yes | no | yes | yes
8749
8750 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8751 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8752 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008753 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008754 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008755 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8756 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8757 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008759 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008760 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008761 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008762
8763 Arguments:
8764 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8765 named "server-state-file".
8766
8767 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8768 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8769 name is used as a file name.
8770
8771 none don't load any stat for this backend
8772
8773 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008774 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8775 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8776 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008778 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008779
8780 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8781 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8782
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008783 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008785 global
8786 stats socket /tmp/socket
8787 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008789 defaults
8790 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008791
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008792 backend bk
8793 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8794 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008795
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008796
8797 Then one can run :
8798
8799 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8800
8801 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8802
8803 1
8804 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8805 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8806 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8807
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008808 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008809
8810 global
8811 stats socket /tmp/socket
8812 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8813
8814 defaults
8815 load-server-state-from-file local
8816
8817 backend bk
8818 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8819 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8820
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008821
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008822 Then one can run :
8823
8824 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8825
8826 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8827
8828 1
8829 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8830 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8831 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8832
8833 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8834 "show servers state"
8835
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008837log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008838log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008839 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008840no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008841 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008844
8845 Prefix :
8846 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8847 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8848 prefix does not allow arguments.
8849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008850 Arguments :
8851 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8852 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8853 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8854 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8855 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8856 parameter.
8857
8858 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8859 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8860
8861 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8862 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8863 standard syslog port).
8864
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008865 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8866 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8867 standard syslog port).
8868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008869 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8870 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8871 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008873
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008874 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8875 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8876 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8877 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8878 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8879 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8880 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8881 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8882 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8883 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8884 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8885 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008886 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008887 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8888 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8889 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008890 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8891 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008892
8893 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8894 and "fd@2", see above.
8895
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008896 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8897 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8898 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8899 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8900 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8901 having the logs instantly available.
8902
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008903 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8904 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8905 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8906
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008907 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8908 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008909
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008910 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8911 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8912 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8913 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8914 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8915 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8916 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8917 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8918 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8919 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008920 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008921
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008922 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8923 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8924 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8925 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8926 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8927
8928 <sample_size>
8929 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8930 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8931 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8932 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8933 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8934
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008935 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8936 one of the following :
8937
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008938 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8939 field is stripped. This is the default.
8940 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8941 rfc3164.
8942
8943 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008944 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8945
8946 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8947 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8948
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008949 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8950 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8951 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8952 designed to be used with a local log server.
8953
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008954 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8955 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8956 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8957 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8958 systemd logger consumes.
8959
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008960 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8961 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8962 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8963 used with a local log server.
8964
8965 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8966 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8967 designed to be used with a local log server.
8968
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008969 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8970 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8971 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8972 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008974 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8975
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008976 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8977 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8978 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8979
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008980 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8981 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8982 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8983 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008984
8985 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8986 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8987 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008988 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8989 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8990 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8991 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8992 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008993
8994 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8995
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008996 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8997 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8998 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008999
9000 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
9001 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
9002 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
9003 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
9004
9005 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
9006 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009007
9008 Example :
9009 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01009010 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
9011 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
9012 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02009013 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02009014 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
9015 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009016 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01009017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009018
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009019log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009020 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
9021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009023
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009024 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
9025 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
9026 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009027 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
9028 format string in depth.
9029
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02009030 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
9031 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009032
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009033 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
9034 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009035
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009036log-format-sd <string>
9037 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
9038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9039 yes | yes | yes | no
9040
9041 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
9042 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
9043 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009044 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009045 which covers the log format string in depth.
9046
9047 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
9048 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
9049
9050 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
9051 log format to "rfc5424".
9052
9053 Example :
9054 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
9055
9056
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009057log-tag <string>
9058 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
9059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 yes | yes | yes | yes
9061
9062 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
9063 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009064 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009065 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
9066 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
9067 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
9068 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
9069 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
9070 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009071
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009072max-keep-alive-queue <value>
9073 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
9074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9075 yes | no | yes | yes
9076
9077 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
9078 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
9079 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
9080 servers.
9081
9082 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009083 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009084 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9085 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9086 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009088 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9089 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9090 picking a different server.
9091
9092 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9093 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9094 even if they have to be queued.
9095
9096 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9097 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9098
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009099max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9100 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9101 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9102 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009105
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009106maxconn <conns>
9107 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 yes | yes | yes | no
9110 Arguments :
9111 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9112 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9113 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9114 closes.
9115
9116 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009117 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009118 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9119 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009120 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9121 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9122 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9123 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009124
9125 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9126 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9127 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9128
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009129 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9130 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009131
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009132 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9133
9134
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009135mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009136 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | yes | yes | yes
9139 Arguments :
9140 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9141 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9142 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9143 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9144
9145 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9146 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9147 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9148 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9149 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009151 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9152 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9153 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009154
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009155 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009156 defaults http_instances
9157 mode http
9158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009159
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009160monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009161 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9163 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009164 Arguments :
9165 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9166 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009167 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009168 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9169 backend and its backup.
9170
9171 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9172 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9173 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9174 servers in a list of backends.
9175
9176 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9177 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9178 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009179 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009180 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9181 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009182 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009183 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9184 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009185
9186 Example:
9187 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009188 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009189 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9190 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9191 monitor-uri /site_alive
9192 monitor fail if site_dead
9193
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009194 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009195
9196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009197monitor-uri <uri>
9198 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9200 yes | yes | yes | no
9201 Arguments :
9202 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9203 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9204
9205 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9206 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9207 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9208 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9209 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9210 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9211 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9212 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9213
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009214 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009215 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9216 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009217 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9218 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9219 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009220 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9221 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9222 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009223
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009224 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9225 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9226 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9227 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9228
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009229 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009230 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009231 frontend www
9232 mode http
9233 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9234
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009235 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009238option abortonclose
9239no option abortonclose
9240 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9242 yes | no | yes | yes
9243 Arguments : none
9244
9245 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9246 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9247 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9248 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009249 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009250 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9251 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9252 encountered while delivering the response.
9253
9254 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9255 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9256 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9257 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9258 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9259 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009260 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009261 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009262 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009263 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9264 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9265 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9266
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009267 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9268 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009269 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9270 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9271 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9272 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9273 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9274 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009275 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009276
9277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9279
9280 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9281
9282
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009283option accept-invalid-http-request
9284no option accept-invalid-http-request
9285 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9287 yes | yes | yes | no
9288 Arguments : none
9289
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009290 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009291 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009292 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009293 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9294 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9295 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9296 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9297 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009298 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9299 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9300 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9301 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009302 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009303 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009304 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009305 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9306 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009307 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9308 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009309
9310 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9311 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9312 been confirmed.
9313
9314 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9315 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009316 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9317 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009318 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9319
9320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9322
9323 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9324 stats socket.
9325
9326
9327option accept-invalid-http-response
9328no option accept-invalid-http-response
9329 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9331 yes | no | yes | yes
9332 Arguments : none
9333
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009334 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009335 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009337 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9338 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9339 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9340 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9341 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009342 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9343 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9344 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009345
9346 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9347 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9348 been confirmed.
9349
9350 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9351 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9352 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9353 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9354
9355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9357
9358 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9359 stats socket.
9360
9361
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009362option allbackups
9363no option allbackups
9364 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 yes | no | yes | yes
9367 Arguments : none
9368
9369 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9370 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9371 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9372 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9373 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9374 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9375 order between the backup servers anymore.
9376
9377 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9378 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9379
9380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9382
9383
9384option checkcache
9385no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009386 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 yes | no | yes | yes
9389 Arguments : none
9390
9391 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9392 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009393 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009394 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9395 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009396 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009397
9398 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009399 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009400 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009401 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9402 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009403 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009404 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009405 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9406 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009407 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009408 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9409 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009410 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009411 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9412 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9414 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9415 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9416 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9417 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9418 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9419 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9420
9421 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009422 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9423 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9424 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9425 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009426
9427 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9428 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009429 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009430 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009431
9432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9434
9435
9436option clitcpka
9437no option clitcpka
9438 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9440 yes | yes | yes | no
9441 Arguments : none
9442
9443 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9444 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009445 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009446 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9447
9448 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9449 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9450 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9451 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9452
9453 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9454 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9455 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9456 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9457 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9458
9459 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9460
9461 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9462 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9463 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9464
9465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9467
9468 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9469
9470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009471option contstats
9472 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 yes | yes | yes | no
9475 Arguments : none
9476
9477 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9478 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9479 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009480 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009481 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9482 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9483 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9484 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9485 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009486
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009487option disable-h2-upgrade
9488no option disable-h2-upgrade
9489 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9490 connection.
9491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9492 yes | yes | yes | no
9493 Arguments : none
9494
9495 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9496 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9497 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9498 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009499 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9500 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9501 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9502 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9503 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9504 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009505
9506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009508
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009509option dontlog-normal
9510no option dontlog-normal
9511 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 yes | yes | yes | no
9514 Arguments : none
9515
9516 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9517 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9518 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9519 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9520 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9521 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9522 logged.
9523
9524 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9525 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9526 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009528 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009529 logging.
9530
9531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009532option dontlognull
9533no option dontlognull
9534 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9536 yes | yes | yes | no
9537 Arguments : none
9538
9539 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9540 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9541 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9542 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9543 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9544 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009545 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9546 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9547 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009548
9549 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009550 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009551 would not be logged.
9552
9553 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9554 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9555
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009556 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009557 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009558
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009559option forwarded [ proto ]
9560 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9561 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9562 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9563no option forwarded
9564 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 yes | no | yes | yes
9567 Arguments :
9568 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9569 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9570
9571 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9572 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9573
9574 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9575 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9576
9577 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9578 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9579
9580 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9581 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9582
9583
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009584 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009585 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9586
9587 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9588 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9589 underlying servers/applications.
9590 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9591 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9592 issues.
9593
9594 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9595 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9596 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9597
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009598 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009599 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9600 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9601 values to an already existing header).
9602
9603 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9604 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9605
9606 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9607 behavior.
9608 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9609
9610 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009611 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009612
9613 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9614 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9615 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9616 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9617 "unknown".
9618
9619 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9620 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9621 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9622 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9623
9624 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9625 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9626 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9627 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9628 "unknown".
9629
9630 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9631 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9632 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9633 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9634
9635 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9636 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9637 it will be ignored.
9638 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9639 otherwise it will be ignored.
9640
9641 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9642 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9643 it will be ignored.
9644 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9645 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9646
9647 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9648 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9649 it will be ignored.
9650 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9651 otherwise it will be ignored.
9652
9653 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9654 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9655 it will be ignored.
9656 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9657 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9658
9659 Examples :
9660 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9661 # Resulting header would look like this:
9662 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9663 backend www_default
9664 mode http
9665 option forwarded
9666 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9667
9668 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9669 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9670 # ip privacy is a concern)
9671 # Resulting header would look like this:
9672 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9673 backend www_host
9674 mode http
9675 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9676
9677 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9678 # Resulting header would look like this:
9679 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9680 backend www_custom
9681 mode http
9682 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9683
9684 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9685 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9686 # Resulting header would look like this:
9687 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9688 backend www_for_hide
9689 mode http
9690 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9691
9692 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009693
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009694option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009695 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9697 yes | yes | yes | yes
9698 Arguments :
9699 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9700 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009701 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009702 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009703
9704 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9705 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9706 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9707 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9708 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9709 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9710 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009711 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9712 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9713 possible that the client has already brought one.
9714
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009715 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009716 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009717 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009718 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009719 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009720 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009721
9722 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9723 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9724 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9725 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9726 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9727 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009728 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009729
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009730 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9731 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009732 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009733 are under the control of the end-user.
9734
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009735 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009736 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9737 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009738 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9739 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9740 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009741
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009742 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009743 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9744 frontend www
9745 mode http
9746 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9747
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009748 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9749 backend www
9750 mode http
9751 option forwardfor header X-Client
9752
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009753 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009754 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009755
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009756
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009757option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9758no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9759 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9761 yes | yes | yes | no
9762 Arguments : none
9763
9764 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9765 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9766 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9767 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9768 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9769 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9770 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9771
9772 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9773 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9774 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9775 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9776 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9777 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9778 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9779 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9780 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9781 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9782
9783 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9784
9785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9787
9788 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9789 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9790
9791
9792option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9793no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9794 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9796 yes | no | yes | yes
9797 Arguments : none
9798
9799 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9800 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9801 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9802 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9803 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9804 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9805 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9806
9807 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9808 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9809 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9810 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9811 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9812 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9813 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9814 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9815 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9816 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9817
9818 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9819
9820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9822
9823 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9824 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9825
9826
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009827option http-buffer-request
9828no option http-buffer-request
9829 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9831 yes | yes | yes | yes
9832 Arguments : none
9833
9834 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9835 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9836 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9837 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9838 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9839 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009840 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9841 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9842 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9843 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009844
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009845 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9846 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009847
9848
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009849option http-ignore-probes
9850no option http-ignore-probes
9851 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9853 yes | yes | yes | no
9854 Arguments : none
9855
9856 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9857 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9858 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9859 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9860 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9861 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9862 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9863 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9864 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009865 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9866 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009867 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9868
9869 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9870 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9871 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9872 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9873 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9874 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9875 are often the only way to detect them.
9876
9877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9879
9880 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9881
9882
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009883option http-keep-alive
9884no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009885 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9886 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9888 yes | yes | yes | yes
9889 Arguments : none
9890
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009891 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009892 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9893 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9894 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9895 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9896 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009897
9898 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9899 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009900 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9901 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9902 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9903 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9904 situations where this option may be useful :
9905
9906 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009907 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009908
9909 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9910 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9911
9912 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009913
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009914 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9915 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9916 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9917 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9918 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9919 not set.
9920
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009921 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009922 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009923
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009924 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009925 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009926
9927
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009928option http-no-delay
9929no option http-no-delay
9930 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9932 yes | yes | yes | yes
9933 Arguments : none
9934
9935 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9936 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9937 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9938 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9939 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9940 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9941 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009942 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009943 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9944 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9945 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9946 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9947 affected.
9948
9949 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9950 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9951 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9952 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9953 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9954 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9955 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9956 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9957 latency environments.
9958
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009959 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9960
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009961
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009962option http-pretend-keepalive
9963no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009964 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9965 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009968 Arguments : none
9969
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009970 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009971 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9972 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9973 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9974 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9975 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9976 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009977
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009978 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009979 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009980 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009981 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009982 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009983 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9984
9985 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9986 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9987 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9988 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009989 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9990 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009991 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9992
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009993 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9994 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9995 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009996 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009997
9998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10000
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010001 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +010010002 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +020010003
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +020010004option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
10005 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
10006 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
10007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10008 yes | yes | yes | yes
10009 Arguments :
10010 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
10011 with no FastCGI application configured.
10012
10013 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
10014 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
10015 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
10016
10017 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
10018 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
10019
10020 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
10021 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
10022 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
10023 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
10024 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
10025 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
10026 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
10027 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
10028
10029 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
10030 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010031
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010032option http-server-close
10033no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010034 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | yes | yes | yes
10037 Arguments : none
10038
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010039 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010040 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10041 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10042 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10043 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
10044 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
10045 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
10046 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
10047 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
10048 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
10049 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
10050 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
10051 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
10052 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010053
10054 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
10055 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
10056 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
10057 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010058 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
10059 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010060
10061 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
10062 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010063 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
10064 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
10065 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010066
10067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10069
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010070 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
10071 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010072
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010073option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010074no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010075 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
10076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | yes | yes | no
10078 Arguments : none
10079
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000010080 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010081 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
10082 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10083 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10084 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10085 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010086 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010087
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010088 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010089 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010090 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10091 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10092 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010093
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010094 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10095 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10096 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10097 front of an existing proxy.
10098
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010099 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10100
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010101 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010102
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010103option httpchk
10104option httpchk <uri>
10105option httpchk <method> <uri>
10106option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010107 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10109 yes | no | yes | yes
10110 Arguments :
10111 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10112 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10113 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10114 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10115 ones.
10116
10117 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10118 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10119 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10120
10121 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10122 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10123 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010124 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010125
10126 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10127 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10128 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10129 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10130 the lack of any response.
10131
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010132 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10133 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10134 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10135 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10136
10137 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10138 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10139 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010140
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010141 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10142 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010143 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010144 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010145 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010146
10147 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010148 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10149 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10150 backend https_relay
10151 mode tcp
10152 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10153 http-check send hdr Host www
10154 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010155
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010156 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10157 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10158 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010159
10160
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010161option httpclose
10162no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010163 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10165 yes | yes | yes | yes
10166 Arguments : none
10167
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010168 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010169 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10170 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10171 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10172 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010173
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010174 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010175 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10176 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010177 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10178 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10179 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010180
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010181 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010182 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10183 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010184
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010185 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010186 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010187
10188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10190
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010191 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010192
10193
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010194option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010195 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010197 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010198 Arguments :
10199 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10200 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10201 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010203 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010204
10205 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10206 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10207 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10208 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10209 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10210 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10211 ports.
10212
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010213 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10214 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010215
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010216 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010218 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010219
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010220option httpslog
10221 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10223 yes | yes | yes | no
10224
10225 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10226 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10227 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10228 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10229 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10230 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10231 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10232
10233 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10234
10235 See also : section 8 about logging.
10236
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010237
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010238option independent-streams
10239no option independent-streams
10240 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10242 yes | yes | yes | yes
10243 Arguments : none
10244
10245 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10246 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10247 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10248 receive data or not.
10249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010250 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010251 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10252 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10253 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10254 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10255 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10256 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10257 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10258 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10259 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10260 socket buffers.
10261
10262 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10263 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10264 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10265 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10266 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10267
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010268 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010269
10270
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010271option ldap-check
10272 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 yes | no | yes | yes
10275 Arguments : none
10276
10277 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10278 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10279 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10280 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10281
10282 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10283 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10284
10285 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10286 configure it.
10287
10288 Example :
10289 option ldap-check
10290
10291 See also : "option httpchk"
10292
10293
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010294option external-check
10295 Use external processes for server health checks
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 yes | no | yes | yes
10298
10299 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10300 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10301 command".
10302
10303 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10304
10305 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10306
10307
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010308option idle-close-on-response
10309no option idle-close-on-response
10310 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10312 yes | yes | yes | no
10313 Arguments : none
10314
10315 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10316 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10317 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10318 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10319 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10320 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10321 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10322 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10323 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10324
10325 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10326 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10327
10328 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10329 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10330 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10331 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10332
10333 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10334 "hard-stop-after"
10335
10336
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010337option log-health-checks
10338no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010339 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10341 yes | no | yes | yes
10342 Arguments : none
10343
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010344 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10345 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10346 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010347
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010348 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10349 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10350 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10351 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10352 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010354 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010355 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010356
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010357 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10358 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10359 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010360
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010361
10362option log-separate-errors
10363no option log-separate-errors
10364 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10366 yes | yes | yes | no
10367 Arguments : none
10368
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010369 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010370 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10371 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10372 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10373 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10374 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10375 provides very important information.
10376
10377 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10378 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10379 error logs.
10380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010381 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010382 logging.
10383
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010384
10385option logasap
10386no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010387 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10389 yes | yes | yes | no
10390 Arguments : none
10391
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010392 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10393 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10394 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10395 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10396
10397 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10398 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10399 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10400 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10401 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010402 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010403 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10404 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10405 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10406 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010407 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010409 Examples :
10410 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10411 mode http
10412 option httplog
10413 option logasap
10414 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10415
10416 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10417 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10418 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10419 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010421 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010422 logging.
10423
10424
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010425option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010426 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10428 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010429 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010430 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10431 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010432 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10433 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010434
10435 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10436 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010437 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010438 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010439 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10440 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10441 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010442
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010443 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10444 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10445 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010446
10447 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010448 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010449 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10450 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10451 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10452 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10453 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10454 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10455 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10456
10457 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10458 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010459
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010460 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010461
10462 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10463 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10464 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10465 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010466 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010467 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010468
10469 See also: "option httpchk"
10470
10471
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010472option nolinger
10473no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010474 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10476 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010477 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010478
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010479 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010480 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10481 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10482 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10483 connections.
10484
10485 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10486 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010487 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10488 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10489 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10490 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10491 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10492 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10493 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10494 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10495 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10496 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10497 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10498 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10499 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010500
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010501 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10502 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10503 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10504 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10505 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010506
10507 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10508 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010509 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010510 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010511 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010512
10513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10515
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010516 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10517 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010518
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010519option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10520 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10522 yes | yes | yes | yes
10523 Arguments :
10524 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10525 matching <network>
10526 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10527 header name.
10528
10529 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10530 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10531 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10532 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10533 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10534 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10535 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10536 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10537 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10538 possible that the client has already brought one.
10539
10540 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10541 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10542 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10543 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10544 header and requires different one.
10545
10546 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10547 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10548 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010549 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10550 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10551 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10552 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10553 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010554
10555 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10556 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10557 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10558 both are defined.
10559
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010560 Examples :
10561 # Original Destination address
10562 frontend www
10563 mode http
10564 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10565
10566 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10567 backend www
10568 mode http
10569 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10570
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010571 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010572
10573
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010574option persist
10575no option persist
10576 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10578 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010579 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010580
10581 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10582 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10583 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10584 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10585 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10586 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10587 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10588 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10589 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10590 redirected to another valid server.
10591
10592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10594
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010595 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010596
10597
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010598option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010599 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10601 yes | no | yes | yes
10602 Arguments :
10603 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10604 PostgreSQL server.
10605
10606 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10607 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10608 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10609 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10610
10611 See also: "option httpchk"
10612
10613
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010614option prefer-last-server
10615no option prefer-last-server
10616 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10618 yes | no | yes | yes
10619 Arguments : none
10620
10621 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010622 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010623 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10624 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010625 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010626 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010627 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010628 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10629 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010630 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010631 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010632 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10633 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10634 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010635 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10636 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10637 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010638
10639 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10640 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10641
10642 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10643
10644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010645option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010646option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010647no option redispatch
10648 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10650 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010651 Arguments :
10652 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10653 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10654 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010655 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010656 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010657 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010658 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10659 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10660 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010662
10663 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10664 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10665 be able to access the service anymore.
10666
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010667 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10668 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010669
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010670 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10671 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10672 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10673 following order:
10674
10675 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10676
10677 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10678 list, or
10679
10680 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10681
10682 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10683 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10684
10685 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10686 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10687 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10688 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10689
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010690 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010691 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10692 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10696
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010697 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010699
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010700option redis-check
10701 Use redis health checks for server testing
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10703 yes | no | yes | yes
10704 Arguments : none
10705
10706 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10707 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10708 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10709 find the "+PONG" response message.
10710
10711 Example :
10712 option redis-check
10713
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010714 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010715
10716
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010717option smtpchk
10718option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10719 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010723 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010724 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010725 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10726
10727 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10728 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10729 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10730
10731 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10732 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10733 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10734 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10735 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10736 dead server.
10737
10738 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10739 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010741 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10742
10743 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10744 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10745 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10746 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010747 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010748
10749 Example :
10750 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10751
10752 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010755option socket-stats
10756no option socket-stats
10757
10758 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10760 yes | yes | yes | no
10761
10762 Arguments : none
10763
10764
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010765option splice-auto
10766no option splice-auto
10767 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10769 yes | yes | yes | yes
10770 Arguments : none
10771
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010772 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010773 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010774 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010775 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010776 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010777 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10778 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10779 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10780 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10781
10782 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10783 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10784 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10785 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10786 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10787 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10788 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10789 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10790 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10791 keyword.
10792
10793 Example :
10794 option splice-auto
10795
10796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10798
10799 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10800 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10801
10802
10803option splice-request
10804no option splice-request
10805 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10807 yes | yes | yes | yes
10808 Arguments : none
10809
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010810 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010811 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010812 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10813 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10814 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10815 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10816
10817 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10818
10819 Example :
10820 option splice-request
10821
10822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10824
10825 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10826 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10827
10828
10829option splice-response
10830no option splice-response
10831 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10833 yes | yes | yes | yes
10834 Arguments : none
10835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010836 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010837 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010838 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10839 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10840 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10841 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10842
10843 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10844
10845 Example :
10846 option splice-response
10847
10848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10850
10851 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10852 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10853
10854
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010855option spop-check
10856 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010858 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010859 Arguments : none
10860
10861 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10862 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10863 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10864 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10865
10866 Example :
10867 option spop-check
10868
10869 See also : "option httpchk"
10870
10871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010872option srvtcpka
10873no option srvtcpka
10874 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10876 yes | no | yes | yes
10877 Arguments : none
10878
10879 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10880 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010882 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10883
10884 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10885 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10886 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10887 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10888
10889 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10890 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10891 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10892 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10893 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10894
10895 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10896
10897 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10898 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10899 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10900
10901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10903
10904 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10905
10906
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010907option ssl-hello-chk
10908 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10910 yes | no | yes | yes
10911 Arguments : none
10912
10913 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10914 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10915 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10916 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10917 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10918 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10919 hello message.
10920
10921 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10922 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10923 messages, which is appreciable.
10924
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010925 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010926 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10927 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010928
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010929 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10930
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010931
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010932option tcp-check
10933 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10935 yes | no | yes | yes
10936
10937 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10938 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10939
10940 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10941 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10942 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10943
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010944 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010945 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10946 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10947 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10948 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10949 only.
10950
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010951 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010952 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010953 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10954 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10955 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10956
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010957 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010958 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10959 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010960 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010961 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10962 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10963 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10964 the respective protocols.
10965 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010966 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010967
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010968 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010969
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010970 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10971 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10972 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10973 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010974
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010975 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10976 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10977 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010978
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010979
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010980 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010981 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010982 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010983 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010984
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010986 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010987 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010988
10989 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10990 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010991 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010992 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010993 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010994 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010995 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010996 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010997 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10998 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010999 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011000 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11001 tcp-check expect string +OK
11002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011003 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011004 (send many headers before analyzing)
11005 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011006 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011007 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
11008 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
11009 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
11010 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011011 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011012
11013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011014 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011015
11016
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011017option tcp-smart-accept
11018no option tcp-smart-accept
11019 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
11020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11021 yes | yes | yes | no
11022 Arguments : none
11023
11024 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
11025 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
11026 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
11027 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
11028 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
11029 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
11030
11031 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
11032 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
11033 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
11034 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
11035
11036 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
11037 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
11038 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011039 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011040
11041 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
11042 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
11043 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
11044
11045 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
11046 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
11047 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
11048
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020011049 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
11050
11051
11052option tcp-smart-connect
11053no option tcp-smart-connect
11054 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
11055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11056 yes | no | yes | yes
11057 Arguments : none
11058
11059 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
11060 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
11061 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
11062 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
11063 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
11064
11065 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
11066 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
11067 complex.
11068
11069 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
11070 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
11071 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
11072
11073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
11074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
11075
11076 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
11077
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011078
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011079option tcpka
11080 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
11081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11082 yes | yes | yes | yes
11083 Arguments : none
11084
11085 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11086 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011088 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11089
11090 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11091 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11092 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11093 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11094
11095 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11096 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11097 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11098 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11099 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11100
11101 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11102
11103 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11104 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11105 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11106 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11107 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11108 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11109 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11110 backends.
11111
11112 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011114
11115option tcplog
11116 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011118 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011119 Arguments : none
11120
11121 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11122 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11123 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11124 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11125 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11126 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11127 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11128 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11129
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011130 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011133
11134
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011135option transparent
11136no option transparent
11137 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011139 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011140 Arguments : none
11141
11142 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11143 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11144 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11145 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11146 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11147 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11148 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11149 appropriate server.
11150
11151 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11152 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11153
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011154 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011155 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011156
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011157
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011158external-check command <command>
11159 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11161 yes | no | yes | yes
11162
11163 Arguments :
11164 <command> is the external command to run
11165
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011166 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11167
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011168 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011169
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011170 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11171 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11172 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11173 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11174 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11175 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011176
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011177 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11178
11179 Environment variables :
11180 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11181 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11182
11183 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11184
11185 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11186
11187 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11188 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11189 for a UNIX socket).
11190
11191 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11192
11193 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11194
11195 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11196
11197 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11198
11199 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11200
11201 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11202 socket).
11203
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011204 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11205
11206 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11207 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11208 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11209 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11210 TCP server).
11211
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011212 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11213 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11214
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011215 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11216
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011217 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11218 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11219 failed.
11220
11221 Example :
11222 external-check command /bin/true
11223
11224 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11225
11226
11227external-check path <path>
11228 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11230 yes | no | yes | yes
11231
11232 Arguments :
11233 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11234
11235 The default path is "".
11236
11237 Example :
11238 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11239
11240 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11241 "external-check command"
11242
11243
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011244persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011245persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011246 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11248 yes | no | yes | yes
11249 Arguments :
11250 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011251 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11252 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011253
11254 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11255 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011256 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011257 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11258 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11259 forwarded to this server.
11260
11261 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11262 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11263 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011264 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011265 a single "listen" section.
11266
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011267 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11268 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11269 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11270
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011271 Example :
11272 listen tse-farm
11273 bind :3389
11274 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11275 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11276 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11277 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11278 persist rdp-cookie
11279 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011280 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011281 balance rdp-cookie
11282 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11283 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11284
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011285 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011286
11287
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011288rate-limit sessions <rate>
11289 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11291 yes | yes | yes | no
11292 Arguments :
11293 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11294 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11295
11296 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11297 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11298 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011299 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011300 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11301 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11302
11303 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11304 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11305 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11306 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11307
11308 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11309 listen smtp
11310 mode tcp
11311 bind :25
11312 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011313 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011314
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011315 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11316 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11317 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011318
11319 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11320
11321
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011322redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11323redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11324redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011325 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11327 no | yes | yes | yes
11328
11329 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011330 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011331
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011332 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011333 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011334 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11335 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011336 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011337
11338 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11339 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11340 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11341 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11342 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011343 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11344 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11345 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011346 in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011347
11348 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11349 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11350 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11351 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11352 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11353 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011354 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011355 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011356 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11357 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011358 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011359
11360 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011361 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11362 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11363 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011364 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011365 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11366 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11367 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11368 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011369
11370 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011372
11373 - "drop-query"
11374 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11375 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11376 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11377 with a location-type redirect.
11378
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011379 - "append-slash"
11380 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11381 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11382 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11383 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11384
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011385 - "ignore-empty"
11386 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11387 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11388 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11389 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11390 of known paths using a simple map.
11391
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011392 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11393 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11394 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11395 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11396 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11397 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11398 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11399
11400 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11401 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11402 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11403 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11404 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11405 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11406 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011407
11408 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11409 acl clear dst_port 80
11410 acl secure dst_port 8080
11411 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011412 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011413 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011414 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11415
11416 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011417 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11418 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11419 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011420 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011421
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011422 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11423 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11424 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11425
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011426 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011427 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011428
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011429 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011430 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11431 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11432 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011433
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011434 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11435 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11436 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011438 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011439
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011440
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011441retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011442 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11444 yes | no | yes | yes
11445 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011446 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11447 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011448
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011449 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11450 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11451 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11452 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11453 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011454
11455 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011456 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011457 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011458
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011459 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11460 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11461 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011462
11463 See also : "option redispatch"
11464
11465
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011466retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011467 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11468 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11469 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11471 yes | no | yes | yes
11472 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011473 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11474 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11475 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11476 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11477 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011478
11479 none never retry
11480
11481 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11482 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11483
11484 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11485 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11486 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11487 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11488 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11489 processing the request.
11490
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011491 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11492 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11493 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11494 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11495 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11496 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11497 overflow attack for example).
11498
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011499 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11500 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11501 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11502 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11503 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11504 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11505 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11506 amplify denial of service attacks.
11507
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011508 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11509 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11510 considered to be safe to retry.
11511
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011512 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11513 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11514 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11515 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11516 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011517
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011518 all-retryable-errors
11519 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011520 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11521 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11522 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011523
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011524 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11525 not cumulative.
11526
11527 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11528 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11529 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11530 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11531
11532 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11533 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11534 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11535 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11536 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11537 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11538 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11539 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11540 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11541 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11542 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11543 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11544
11545 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11546 should not use this directive.
11547
11548 The default is "conn-failure".
11549
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011550 Example:
11551 retry-on 503 504
11552
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011553 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11554
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011555server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011556 Declare a server in a backend
11557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11558 no | no | yes | yes
11559 Arguments :
11560 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011562 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011563
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011564 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11565 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11566 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11567 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011568 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11569 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011570 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011571 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11572 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011573 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11574 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11575 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11576 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11577 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11578 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11579 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011580 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011581 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11582 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11583 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11584 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11585 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11586 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011587 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11588 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011589 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11590 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011591
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011592 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011593 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11594 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11595 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11596 adding this value to the client's port.
11597
11598 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11599 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011600 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011601
11602 Examples :
11603 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11604 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011605 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011606 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11607 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11608 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011609
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011610 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11611 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11612 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11613 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11614 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11615
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011616 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11617 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011618
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011619server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011620 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011621 this backend.
11622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11623 no | no | yes | yes
11624
11625 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11626 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11627 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11628 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11629 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011630
11631 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11632 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11633
11634 global
11635 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11636
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011637 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011638 load-server-state-from-file
11639
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011640 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011641 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011642
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011643server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11644 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11645 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11647 no | no | yes | yes
11648
11649 Arguments:
11650 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11651
11652 <num | range>
11653 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11654 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11655 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11656 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11657
11658 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11659
11660 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11661
11662 <params*>
11663 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11664 keyword.
11665
11666 Examples:
11667 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11668 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11669 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11670
11671 # or
11672 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11673
11674 # would be equivalent to:
11675 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11676 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11677 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11678
11679
11680
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011681source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011682source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011683source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011684 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11686 yes | no | yes | yes
11687 Arguments :
11688 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11689 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011690
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011691 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011692 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11693 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11694 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11695 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11696 supported prefixes are :
11697 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11698 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11699 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011700 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011701 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11702 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011703
11704 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11705 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011706 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11707 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11708 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011709
11710 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11711 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11712 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11713 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11714 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11715 <addr>.
11716
11717 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11718 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11719 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11720 port.
11721
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011722 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11723 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11724 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11725 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011726 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011727 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11728 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11729 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11730 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11731 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11732 HTTP header.
11733
11734 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11735 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011736 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011737 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11738 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11739 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11740 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11741 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11742 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11743 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11744
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011745 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11746 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11747 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11748 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11749 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11750 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11751
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011752 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11753 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11754 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11755 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11756
11757 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11758 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11759 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11760 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11761 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11762 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11763
11764 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11765 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11766 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11767 there are two methods :
11768
11769 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11770 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11771 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11772 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11773 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11774 of the client ranges may be used.
11775
11776 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11777 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11778 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11779 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11780 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11781 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11782 same session.
11783
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011784 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11785 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11786 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011787 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011788
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011789 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11790 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011792 Examples :
11793 backend private
11794 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11795 source 192.168.1.200
11796
11797 backend transparent_ssl1
11798 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11799 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11800
11801 backend transparent_ssl2
11802 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11803 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11804 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11805
11806 backend transparent_ssl3
11807 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11808 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11809 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11810
11811 backend transparent_smtp
11812 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11813 # with Tproxy version 4.
11814 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11815
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011816 backend transparent_http
11817 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11818 # proxy.
11819 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011821 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011822 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11823
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011824
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011825srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11826 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11827 the connection on the server side.
11828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11829 yes | no | yes | yes
11830 Arguments :
11831 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11832
11833 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11834 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011835 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11836 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011837
11838 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11839
11840
11841srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11842 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11843 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11844 server side.
11845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11846 yes | no | yes | yes
11847 Arguments :
11848 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11849 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11850 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11851 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11852
11853 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11854 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011855 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11856 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011857
11858 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11859
11860
11861srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11862 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11864 yes | no | yes | yes
11865 Arguments :
11866 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11867 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11868 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11869 document.
11870
11871 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11872 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011873 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11874 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011875
11876 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11877
11878
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011879stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11880 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011882 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011883
11884 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11885 matched.
11886
11887 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11888 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11889
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011890 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11891 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11892 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11893 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011894
11895 Example :
11896 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11897 backend stats_localhost
11898 stats enable
11899 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11900
11901 Example :
11902 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11903 backend stats_auth
11904 stats enable
11905 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11906 stats admin if TRUE
11907
11908 Example :
11909 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11910 userlist stats-auth
11911 group admin users admin
11912 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11913 group readonly users haproxy
11914 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11915
11916 backend stats_auth
11917 stats enable
11918 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11919 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11920 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11921 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11922
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011923 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11924 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011925
11926
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011927stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11928 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011930 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011931 Arguments :
11932 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11933
11934 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11935
11936 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11937 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11938 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11939 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11940 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11941 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11942
11943 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11944 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11945 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011946 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011947
11948 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11949 report using "stats scope".
11950
11951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11953 unobvious parameters.
11954
11955 Example :
11956 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11957 backend public_www
11958 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11959 stats enable
11960 stats hide-version
11961 stats scope .
11962 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011963 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011964 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11965 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11966
11967 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11968 backend private_monitoring
11969 stats enable
11970 stats uri /admin?stats
11971 stats refresh 5s
11972
11973 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11974
11975
11976stats enable
11977 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011979 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011980 Arguments : none
11981
11982 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11983 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11984 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11985 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11986 - stats auth : no authentication
11987 - stats scope : no restriction
11988
11989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11991 unobvious parameters.
11992
11993 Example :
11994 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11995 backend public_www
11996 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11997 stats enable
11998 stats hide-version
11999 stats scope .
12000 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012002 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12003 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12004
12005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12006 backend private_monitoring
12007 stats enable
12008 stats uri /admin?stats
12009 stats refresh 5s
12010
12011 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12012
12013
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012014stats hide-version
12015 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012018 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012020 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
12021 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
12022 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
12023 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
12024 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
12025 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012027 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12028 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12029 unobvious parameters.
12030
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012031 Example :
12032 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12033 backend public_www
12034 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012035 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012036 stats hide-version
12037 stats scope .
12038 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012039 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012040 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12041 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012042
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12044 backend private_monitoring
12045 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012046 stats uri /admin?stats
12047 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010012048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012049 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012050
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012051
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020012052stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
12053 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12054 Access control for statistics
12055
12056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12057 no | no | yes | yes
12058
12059 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
12060 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
12061 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
12062 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
12063 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
12064 should be asked to enter a username and password.
12065
12066 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
12067 instance.
12068
12069 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
12070 about ACL usage.
12071
12072
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012073stats realm <realm>
12074 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
12075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012077 Arguments :
12078 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
12079 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
12080 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
12081
12082 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12083 using a backslash ('\').
12084
12085 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12086 only related to authentication.
12087
12088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12090 unobvious parameters.
12091
12092 Example :
12093 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12094 backend public_www
12095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12096 stats enable
12097 stats hide-version
12098 stats scope .
12099 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012100 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012101 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12102 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12103
12104 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12105 backend private_monitoring
12106 stats enable
12107 stats uri /admin?stats
12108 stats refresh 5s
12109
12110 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12111
12112
12113stats refresh <delay>
12114 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012117 Arguments :
12118 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12119 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12120 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12121 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12122 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12123 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12124
12125 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12126 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12127 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012128 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012129
12130 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12131 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12132 unobvious parameters.
12133
12134 Example :
12135 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12136 backend public_www
12137 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12138 stats enable
12139 stats hide-version
12140 stats scope .
12141 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012142 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012143 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12144 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12145
12146 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12147 backend private_monitoring
12148 stats enable
12149 stats uri /admin?stats
12150 stats refresh 5s
12151
12152 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12153
12154
12155stats scope { <name> | "." }
12156 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012158 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012159 Arguments :
12160 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12161 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12162 section in which the statement appears.
12163
12164 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12165 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12166 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12167 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12168 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12169 exists.
12170
12171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12173 unobvious parameters.
12174
12175 Example :
12176 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12177 backend public_www
12178 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12179 stats enable
12180 stats hide-version
12181 stats scope .
12182 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012183 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012184 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12185 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12186
12187 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12188 backend private_monitoring
12189 stats enable
12190 stats uri /admin?stats
12191 stats refresh 5s
12192
12193 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012195
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012196stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012197 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012200
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012201 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012202 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12203
12204 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12205 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12206
12207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012209 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012210
12211 Example :
12212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12213 backend private_monitoring
12214 stats enable
12215 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12216 stats uri /admin?stats
12217 stats refresh 5s
12218
12219 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12220 global section.
12221
12222
12223stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012224 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12226 yes | yes | yes | yes
12227 Arguments : none
12228
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012229 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012230 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12231 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12232 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12233 - IP (socket, server)
12234 - cookie (backend, server)
12235
12236 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12237 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012238 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012239
12240 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12241
12242
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012243stats show-modules
12244 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12246 yes | yes | yes | yes
12247 Arguments : none
12248
12249 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12250 values as a tooltip.
12251
12252 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12253 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12254 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12255
12256 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12257
12258
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012259stats show-node [ <name> ]
12260 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012262 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012263 Arguments:
12264 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12265 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12266
12267 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12268 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012269 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012270
12271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12273 unobvious parameters.
12274
12275 Example:
12276 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12277 backend private_monitoring
12278 stats enable
12279 stats show-node Europe-1
12280 stats uri /admin?stats
12281 stats refresh 5s
12282
12283 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12284 section.
12285
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012286
12287stats uri <prefix>
12288 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012290 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012291 Arguments :
12292 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12293 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12294 query string.
12295
12296 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12297 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12298 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12299 possible to reach it in the application.
12300
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012301 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012302 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012303 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12304 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12305 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12306 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12307
12308 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12309 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12310 an address or a port to statistics only.
12311
12312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12314 unobvious parameters.
12315
12316 Example :
12317 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12318 backend public_www
12319 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12320 stats enable
12321 stats hide-version
12322 stats scope .
12323 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012324 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012325 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12326 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12327
12328 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12329 backend private_monitoring
12330 stats enable
12331 stats uri /admin?stats
12332 stats refresh 5s
12333
12334 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12335
12336
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012337stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12338 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012340 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012341
12342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012343 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012344 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012345 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012346 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12347
12348 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12349 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12350 the "stick-table" statement.
12351
12352 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12353 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12354 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12355 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12356 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12357
12358 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12359 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12360 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12361 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12362 transformation rules.
12363
12364 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12365 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12366 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12367 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12368 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12369 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12370 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12371
12372 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12373 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12374 ACL based conditions.
12375
12376 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12377 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12378 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12379 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12380
12381 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12382 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12383 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12384 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12385
12386 Example :
12387 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12388 # last 30 minutes
12389 backend pop
12390 mode tcp
12391 balance roundrobin
12392 stick store-request src
12393 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12394 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12395 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12396
12397 backend smtp
12398 mode tcp
12399 balance roundrobin
12400 stick match src table pop
12401 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12402 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12403
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012404 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12405 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012406
12407
12408stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12409 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12411 no | no | yes | yes
12412
12413 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12414 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12415 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12416 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12417
12418 Examples :
12419 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012420 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012421
12422 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12423 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12424 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12425
12426
12427 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12428 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12429 backend http
12430 mode http
12431 balance roundrobin
12432 stick on src table https
12433 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12434 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12435 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12436
12437 backend https
12438 mode tcp
12439 balance roundrobin
12440 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12441 stick on src
12442 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12443 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12444
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012445 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012446
12447
12448stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12449 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12451 no | no | yes | yes
12452
12453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012454 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012455 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012456 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012457 server is selected.
12458
12459 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12460 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12461 the "stick-table" statement.
12462
12463 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12464 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12465 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12466 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12467 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12468 address.
12469
12470 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12471 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12472 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12473 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12474 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12475 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12476 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12477 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12478 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12479 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12480
12481 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12482 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12483 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12484 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12485 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12486 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12487 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12488
12489 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12490 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12491 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12492 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12493
12494 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12495 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12496 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12497 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12498 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12499 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012500 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12501 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12502 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12503 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12504 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12505 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012506
12507 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12508 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12509 the request.
12510
12511 Example :
12512 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12513 # last 30 minutes
12514 backend pop
12515 mode tcp
12516 balance roundrobin
12517 stick store-request src
12518 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12519 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12520 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12521
12522 backend smtp
12523 mode tcp
12524 balance roundrobin
12525 stick match src table pop
12526 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12527 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12528
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012529 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012530
12531
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012532stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012533 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012534 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012535 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012537 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012538
12539 Arguments :
12540 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12541 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12542 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12543 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12544
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012545 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12546 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12547 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12548 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12549
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012550 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12551 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12552 instance.
12553
12554 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12555 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12556 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12557 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12558 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12559 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012560 to 32 characters.
12561
12562 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12563 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12564 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012565 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012566 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12567 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012568
12569 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012570 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12571 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012572 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12573 increase.
12574
12575 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012576 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12577 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12578 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012579
12580 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012581 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012582 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12583 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012584 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012585 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12586 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12587 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12588 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12589 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12590 parameter (see below).
12591
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012592 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12593 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12594 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12595 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12596 soft restart.
12597
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012598 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012599 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12600 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012601 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12602 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012603 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012604 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012605 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12606 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012607 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12608 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012609
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012610 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12611 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12612 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12613 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12614 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12615 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12616 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12617 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12618 token.
12619
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012620 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12621 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12622 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12623 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012624 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12625 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12626 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12627 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12628 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12629 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12630 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12631 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12632 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12633 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12634 types and their arguments.
12635
12636 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12637 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12638 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12639 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12640
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012641 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12642 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12643 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12644 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12645 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12646 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12647 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12648 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12649 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12650 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012651 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12652 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12653 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12654 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012655
12656 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12657 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12658 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12659 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12660 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12661 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012662 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12663 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12664 update message can fit into the buffer.
12665 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12666 store only the counter gpc0.
12667 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012668 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12669 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12670 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012671 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12672 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12673 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12674 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012675
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012676 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12677 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12678 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012679 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012680
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012681 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12682 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12683 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012684 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012685 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012686 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012687
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012688 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12689 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12690 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12691 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12692
12693 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12694 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12695 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12696 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12697 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12698 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12699
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012700 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12701 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12702 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12703 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12704 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012705 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12706 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12707 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12708 to store only the tag gpt0.
12709 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12710 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12711 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012712 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12713 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12714 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012715
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012716 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12717 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12718 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12719 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12720
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012721 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12722 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12723 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12724 they were received.
12725
12726 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12727 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12728 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12729 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12730 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12731
12732 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12733 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12735 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12736 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12737
12738 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12739 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12740 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12741
12742 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12743 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12744 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12745 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12746 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12747
12748 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12749 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12750 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12751 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12752 the client side.
12753
12754 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12755 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12756 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12757 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12758 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12759 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12760 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12761
12762 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12763 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12764 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12765 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12766 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12767 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012768 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012769
12770 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12773 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12774 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12775 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12776
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012777 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12778 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12779 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12780 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12781 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12782
12783 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12784 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12786 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12787 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12788 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12789
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012790 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012791 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012792 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12793 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12794
12795 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12798 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12799 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12800 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12801 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12802 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12803 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12804 recommended for better fairness.
12805
12806 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012807 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012808 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12809 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12810
12811 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12812 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12813 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12814 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12815 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12816 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12817 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12818 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12819 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12820 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012821
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012822 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12823 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012824 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12825 reference it.
12826
12827 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12828 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012829 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12830 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12831 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012832
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012833 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12834 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12835 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12836 something that can be ignored.
12837
12838 Example:
12839 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12840 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12841 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12842 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12843
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012844 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012845 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012846
12847
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012848stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012849 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12851 no | no | yes | yes
12852
12853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012854 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012855 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012856 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012857 server is selected.
12858
12859 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12860 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12861 the "stick-table" statement.
12862
12863 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12864 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12865 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12866 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12867
12868 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12869 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12870 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12871 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12872 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12873 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012874 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012875 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12876 rules.
12877
12878 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12879 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12880 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12881 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12882 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12883 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12884 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12885
12886 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12887 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12888 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12889 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12890
12891 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12892 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12893 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12894 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12895 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12896 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012897 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12898 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12899 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12900 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12901 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12902 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12903 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12904 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12905 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012906
12907 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12908
12909 Example :
12910 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12911 backend https
12912 mode tcp
12913 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012914 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012915 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012916
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012917 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012918 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012919
12920 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12921 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12922 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12923
12924 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12925 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012926
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012927 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12928 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12929 # at offset 44.
12930
12931 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012932 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012933
12934 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012935 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012936
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012937 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12938 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12939
12940 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12941 extraction.
12942
12943
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012944tcp-check comment <string>
12945 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12946 it fails.
12947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12948 yes | no | yes | yes
12949
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012950 Arguments :
12951 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12952 rule fails.
12953
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012954 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12955 user-friendly error reporting.
12956
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012957 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12958 "tcp-check expect".
12959
12960
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012961tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12962 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012963 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012964 Opens a new connection
12965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012966 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012967
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012968 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012969 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12970
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012971 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012972 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012973
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012974 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012975 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12976 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012977 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012978
12979 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012980
12981 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12982
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012983 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12984
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012985 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12986
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012987 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12988
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012989 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12990 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12991 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12992 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12993
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012994 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12995 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12996 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12997 haproxy -vv.
12998
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012999 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013000
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013001 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
13002 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
13003 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
13004
13005 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
13006 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
13007 of the sequence.
13008
13009 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
13010 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
13011 do.
13012
13013 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
13014 unset-var or comment rules.
13015
13016 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013017 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
13018 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
13019 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
13020 option tcp-check
13021 tcp-check connect
13022 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13023 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13024 tcp-check send \r\n
13025 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13026 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
13027 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13028 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13029 tcp-check send \r\n
13030 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13031 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
13032
13033 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
13034 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013035 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013036 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13037 tcp-check connect port 143
13038 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13039 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
13040
13041 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
13042
13043
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013044tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013045 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013046 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013047 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013048 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013050 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013051
13052 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013053 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13054
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013055 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
13056 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
13057 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
13058 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
13059 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
13060 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
13061 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
13062 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
13063 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
13064 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
13065
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013066 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013067 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
13068 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013069 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
13070 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
13071 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
13072
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013073 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13074 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
13075 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013076 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
13077 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013078 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13079 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013080 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
13081 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013082 By default "L7OK" is used.
13083
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013084 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13085 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013086 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13087 supported :
13088 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13089 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013090 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13091 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13092 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13093 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13094 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013095
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013096 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013097 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013098 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13099 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13100 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13101 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013102 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13103
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013104 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13105 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13106 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13107 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13108
13109 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13110 informational message reported in logs if an error
13111 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13112 log-format string.
13113
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013114 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13115 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13116 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13117 followed by some converters.
13118
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013119 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13120 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13121 with the usual backslash ('\').
13122 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013123 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013124 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13125 used upper or lower case.
13126
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013127 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13128
13129 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13130 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13131 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13132 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13133 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13134 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13135 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13136 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13137
13138 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13139 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13140 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13141 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13142 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13143 expression.
13144
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013145 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13146 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13147 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13148 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13149 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13150 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13151
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013152 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13153 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13154 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13155 this exact hexadecimal string.
13156 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13157
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013158 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13159 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13160 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13161 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13162 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13163 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13164 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13165 size.
13166
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013167 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13168 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13169 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13170 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13171 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13172 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13173 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13174 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13175 in a binary string before matching the response's
13176 buffer.
13177
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013178 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013179 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013180 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13181 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13182 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13183 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13184 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13185 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13186 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13187 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13188 the null character.
13189
13190 Examples :
13191 # perform a POP check
13192 option tcp-check
13193 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13194
13195 # perform an IMAP check
13196 option tcp-check
13197 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13198
13199 # look for the redis master server
13200 option tcp-check
13201 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013202 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013203 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13204 tcp-check expect string role:master
13205 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13206 tcp-check expect string +OK
13207
13208
13209 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013210 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013211
13212
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013213tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13214tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13215 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13216 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013219
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013220 Arguments :
13221 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13222
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013223 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13224 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013225
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013226 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13227 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013228
13229 Examples :
13230 # look for the redis master server
13231 option tcp-check
13232 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13233 tcp-check expect string role:master
13234
13235 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013236 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013237
13238
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013239tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13240tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13241 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13242 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013244 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013245
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013246 Arguments :
13247 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013248
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013249 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13250 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013251
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013252 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13253 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13254 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013255
13256 Examples :
13257 # redis check in binary
13258 option tcp-check
13259 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13260 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13261
13262
13263 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013264 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013265
13266
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013267tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13268tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013269 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013271 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013272
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013273 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013274 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13275 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13276 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13277 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13278 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13279 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13280 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13281 and '-'.
13282
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013283 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13284 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013285 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013286 conditions.
13287
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013288 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13289
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013290 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020013291 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013292
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013293 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013294 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013295 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013296
13297
13298tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013299 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013301 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013302
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013303 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013304 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13305 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13308 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13310 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13311 and '-'.
13312
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013313 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013314 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13315
13316
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013317tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013318 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013320 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013321 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013322 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13323 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013325 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013326
13327 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13328 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013329 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13330 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13331 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13332 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13333 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13334 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013335
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013336 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13337 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13338 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013339 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13340 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13341 is true.
13342
13343 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13344 supported:
13345 - accept
13346 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13347 - expect-proxy layer4
13348 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013349 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013350 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13351 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13352 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13353 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13354 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13355 - set-dst <expr>
13356 - set-dst-port <expr>
13357 - set-mark <mark>
13358 - set-src <expr>
13359 - set-src-port <expr>
13360 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013361 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13362 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013363 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013364 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13365 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13366 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013367 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013368
13369 The supported actions are described below.
13370
13371 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13372 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013373
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013374 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13375 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13376 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13377 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13378 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13379 a defaults section defining such rules.
13380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013381 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13382 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13383 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013385 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13386 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13387 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013388
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013389 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13390 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13391 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013393 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13394 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13395 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013397 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13398 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13399 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013400
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013401 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013403 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013405 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013406
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013407 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013408
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013409tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013410
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013411 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13412 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013413
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013414tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013417 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13418 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13419 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13420 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13421 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13422 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13423 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013424
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013425tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013426
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013427 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13428 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13429 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13430 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13431 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13432 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013433
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013434tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013435
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013436 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13437 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13438 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13439 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13440 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13441 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13442 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13443 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13444 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13445 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13446 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013447
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013448tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13449 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13450
13451 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13452 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13453 a complete description.
13454
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013455tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13456tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13457tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013458
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013459 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13460 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13461 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13462 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013463
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013464tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13466tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013468
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013469 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13470 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013471 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013472
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013473tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13474tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013476 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13477 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13478 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013479
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013480tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013482 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13483 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13484 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013485
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013486tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13487tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013488
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013489 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13490 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13491 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013492
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013493tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013494
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013495 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13496 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13497 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013498
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013499tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13500tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013501
13502 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13503 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13504 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13505 for a complete description.
13506
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013507tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013508
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013509 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13510 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13511 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13512 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013513
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013514tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13515tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13516tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013517
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013518 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13519 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13520 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013521
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013522tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13523
13524 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13525 details about variables.
13526
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013528tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13529 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013531 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013532 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013533 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13534 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013536 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013537
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013538 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013539 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13540 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013541 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13542 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013544 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13545 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13546 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13547 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013548 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013549 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013550 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13551 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13552 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13553 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013554 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013555 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013557 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13558 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13559 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13560 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013561
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013562 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13563 supported:
13564 - accept
13565 - capture <sample> len <length>
13566 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13567 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013568 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013569 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013570 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013571 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013572 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013573 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013574 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013575 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013576 - set-dst <expr>
13577 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013578 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013579 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013580 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013581 - set-priority-class <expr>
13582 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013583 - set-src <expr>
13584 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013585 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013586 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13587 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013588 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013589 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013590 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13591 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13592 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013593 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013594 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013595
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013596 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013597
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013598 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13599 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13600 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13601 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13602 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13603 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013604
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013605 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13606 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13607 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13608 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13609 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13610 a defaults section defining such rules.
13611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013612 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013613 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13614 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013615
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013616 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13617 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13618 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13619 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13620 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13621 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013623 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013624 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13625 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13626 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13627 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13628 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13629 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13630 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13631 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13632 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13633 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013634
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013635 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013636 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13637 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13638 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013639
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013640 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013641 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013642
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013643 Example:
13644
13645 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013646 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013647 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013648
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013649 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013650 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013651 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013652 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13653 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013654 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013655 tcp-request content reject
13656
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013657 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13658 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13659 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13660 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13661 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13662 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13663 ...
13664 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013666 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013667 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13668 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013669 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013670 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013671
13672 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13673 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013674 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013675 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013676 tcp-request content reject
13677
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013678 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013679 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013680 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013681 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013682 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13683 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013684
13685 Example:
13686 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13687 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013688 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013690 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013691 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013692
13693 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013694 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013695 # protecting all our sites
13696 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013697 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13698 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013699 ...
13700 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13701
13702 backend http_dynamic
13703 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013704 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013705 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013706 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013707 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013708 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013709 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013712
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013713 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13714 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013715
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013716tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13717
13718 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013719 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013720
13721tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13723
13724 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13725 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13726 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13727 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13728 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13729 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13730 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13731 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13732 information.
13733
13734tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13735
13736 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13737 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13738 complete description.
13739
13740tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13741
13742 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13743 are evaluated.
13744
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013745tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13746 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13747
13748 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13749 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13750 a complete description.
13751
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013752tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13753tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13754tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13755
13756 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13757 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13758 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13759 description.
13760
13761tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13762 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13763tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13764 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13765
13766 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13767 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013768 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013769
13770tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13771 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13772
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013773 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013774 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13775
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013776tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13777 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013778
13779 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13780 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13781 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13782
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013783tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13784tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13785
13786 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13787 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13788 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13789
13790tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13791
13792 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13793 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13794
13795tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13796
13797 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13798 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13799 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13800
13801tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13802
13803 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13804 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13805
13806tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13807
13808 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13809 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13810
13811tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13812
13813 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13814 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13815 description.
13816
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013817tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13818tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13819
13820 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13821 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13822 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13823
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013824tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13825
13826 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13827 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13828 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13829
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013830tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13831tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013832
13833 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13834 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13835 for a complete description.
13836
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013837tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013838
13839 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13840 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13841 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13842 complete description.
13843
13844tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13846
13847 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13848 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13849 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13850 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13851 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13852 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13853 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13854 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13855 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13856 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13857
13858 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13859
13860tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13861tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13862tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13863
13864 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13865 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13866 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13867
13868tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13869
13870 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13871 details about variables.
13872
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013873tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013874
13875 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13876 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13877 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13878 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13879 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13880
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013881
13882tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13883 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013885 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013886 Arguments :
13887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13889 as explained at the top of this document.
13890
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013891 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013892 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13893 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13894 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13895 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13896
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013897 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13898 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13899 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13900 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13901
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013902 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013903 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013904 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013905 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013906 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013907 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13908 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13909 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013910
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013911 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13912 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13913
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013914 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13915 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13916 it pass through unaffected.
13917
13918 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13919 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13920 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013921 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013922 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13923 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013924 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13925 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13926 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013927
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013928 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13929 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13930
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013931 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013932 "timeout client".
13933
13934
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013935tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13936 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013938 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013939 Arguments :
13940 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13941 below.
13942
13943 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13944
13945 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13946 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13947 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13948 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013949 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013950 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13951 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13952 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13953 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13954 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13955 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13956 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13957 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13958 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13959 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13960 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13961 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13962 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13963 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13964 instead.
13965
13966 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13967 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13968 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13969 rules which may be inserted.
13970
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013971 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13972 supported:
13973 - accept
13974 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013975 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013976 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13977 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13978 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13979 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13980 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013981 - set-dst <expr>
13982 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013983 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013984 - set-src <expr>
13985 - set-src-port <expr>
13986 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013987 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13988 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013989 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013990 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13991 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13992 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13993 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013995 The supported actions are described below.
13996
13997 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13998 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13999 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14000 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14001 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14002 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014003
14004 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14005 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14006 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
14007
14008 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
14009 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
14010 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
14011 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
14012 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
14013
14014 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
14015 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14016
14017 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
14018 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
14019 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
14020
14021 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14022 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
14023 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14024
14025 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
14026 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
14027 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
14028
14029 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14030 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14031 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
14032
14033 See section 7 about ACL usage.
14034
14035 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
14036
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014037tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14038
14039 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
14040 rules are evaluated.
14041
14042tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14043
14044 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
14045 are evaluated.
14046
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014047tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14048 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14049
14050 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14051 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14052 a complete description.
14053
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014054tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14055tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14056tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14057
14058 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14059 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14060 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14061 description.
14062
14063tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14064 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14065tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14066 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14067
14068 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14069 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014070 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014071 description.
14072
14073tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14074tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14075
14076 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
14077 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
14078 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
14079
14080tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14081
14082 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14083 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14084 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14085
14086tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14087tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14088
14089 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14090 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14091 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14092
14093tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14094
14095 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14096 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14097 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14098
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014099tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14100tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014101
14102 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14103 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14104 for a complete description.
14105
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014106tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014107
14108 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14109 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14110 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14111 complete description.
14112
14113tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14114tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14115tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14116
14117 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14118 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14119 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14120
14121tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14122
14123 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14124 details about variables.
14125
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014126
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014127tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14128 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014130 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014131 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014132 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14133 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014134
14135 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014138 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14139 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014140 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14141 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014142
14143 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14144
14145 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14146 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14147 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14148 inserted.
14149
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014150 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14151 supported:
14152 - accept
14153 - close
14154 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014155 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014156 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14157 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14158 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14159 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14160 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14161 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014162 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014163 - set-log-level <level>
14164 - set-mark <mark>
14165 - set-nice <nice>
14166 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014167 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14168 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014169 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014170 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14171
14172 The supported actions are described below.
14173
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014174 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14175 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14176 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14177 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14178 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14179 a defaults section defining such rules.
14180
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014181 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14182 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14183 for changing the default action to a reject.
14184
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014185 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014186
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014187 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14188 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14189 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14190 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14191 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014192
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014193 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014194
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014195 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014196
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014197tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014198
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014199 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14200 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014201
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014202tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014203
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014204 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14205 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14206 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14207 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14208 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14209 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014210
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014211tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014212
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014213 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14214 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014215
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014216tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14218
14219 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14220 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14221 a complete description.
14222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014223tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14224tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14225tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014226
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014227 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14228 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14229 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14230 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014231
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014232tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14234tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014236
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014237 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14238 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014239 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014240
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014241tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14242 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014243
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014244 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014245 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014246
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014247
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014248tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14249 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014250
14251 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14252 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14253 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14254
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014255tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014256
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014257 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14258 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014259
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014260tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014261
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014262 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14263 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14264 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014265
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014266tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014267
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014268 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14269 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014270
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014271tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014272
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014273 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14274 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14275 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014276
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014277tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14278tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014279
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014280 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14281 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14282 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014283
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014284tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014285
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14287 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14288 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14289 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014290
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014291tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014292
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014293 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14294 details about variables.
14295
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014296
14297tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14298 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014300 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014301 Arguments :
14302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14304 as explained at the top of this document.
14305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014306 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14307 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014308
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014309 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14310
14311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014312timeout check <timeout>
14313 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14314 established.
14315
14316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14317 yes | no | yes | yes
14318 Arguments:
14319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14321 as explained at the top of this document.
14322
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014323 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014324 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014326 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014327 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14328 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14329 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014330
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014331 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014332 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14333
14334 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14335 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014336 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014337
14338 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14339 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14340 forget about it.
14341
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014342 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14343 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014344
14345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014346timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014347 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14349 yes | yes | yes | no
14350 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014351 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014352 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14353 as explained at the top of this document.
14354
14355 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14356 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14357 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014358 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14359 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14360 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14361 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014362 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14363 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14364 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014365 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014366 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014367 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14368 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014369 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14370 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014371
14372 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14373 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14374 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14375 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014376 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014377 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14378
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014379 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014381
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014382timeout client-fin <timeout>
14383 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14385 yes | yes | yes | no
14386 Arguments :
14387 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14388 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14389 as explained at the top of this document.
14390
14391 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14392 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14393 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14394 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14395 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14396 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14397 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014398 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14399 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14400 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014401
14402 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14403 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14404 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14405
14406 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14407
14408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014409timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014410 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14412 yes | no | yes | yes
14413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14416 as explained at the top of this document.
14417
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014418 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014419 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014420 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014422 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14423 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014424
14425 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14426 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14427 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14428 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014429 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014430 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14431
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014432 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014434
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014435timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14436 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14438 yes | yes | yes | yes
14439 Arguments :
14440 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14441 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14442 as explained at the top of this document.
14443
14444 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14445 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14446 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14447 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14448 once the request has started to present itself.
14449
14450 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14451 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14452 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14453 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14454 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14455
14456 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14457 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14458 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14459 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14460
14461 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14462 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014463 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014464 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14465 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014466 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014467
14468 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14469 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14470 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14471 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14472
14473 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14474
14475
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014476timeout http-request <timeout>
14477 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014479 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014481 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014482 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14483 as explained at the top of this document.
14484
14485 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14486 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14487 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14488 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14489 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14490 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14491 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014492 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14493 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14494 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14495 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014496 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014497 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14498 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014499
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014500 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14501 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14502 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14503 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14504 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014505 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014506
14507 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14508 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014509 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014510 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14511 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14512
14513 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014514 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14515 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14516 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014517
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014518 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014519 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014520
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014521
14522timeout queue <timeout>
14523 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14525 yes | no | yes | yes
14526 Arguments :
14527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14529 as explained at the top of this document.
14530
14531 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14532 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14533 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14534 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14535 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14536
14537 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14538 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14539 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14540 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14541
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014542 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014543
14544
14545timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014546 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14548 yes | no | yes | yes
14549 Arguments :
14550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14552 as explained at the top of this document.
14553
14554 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14555 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14556 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14557 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14558 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14559 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14560 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14561
14562 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14563 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14564 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14565 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14566 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014567 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014568 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014569 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14570 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014571 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14572 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014573
14574 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14575 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14576 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14577 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014578 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014579 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14580
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014581 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014582
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014583
14584timeout server-fin <timeout>
14585 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14587 yes | no | yes | yes
14588 Arguments :
14589 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14590 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14591 as explained at the top of this document.
14592
14593 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14594 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14595 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14596 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14597 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14598 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14599 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14600 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14601 situations, it should not be needed.
14602
14603 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14604 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14605 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14606
14607 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14608
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014609
14610timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014611 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14613 yes | yes | yes | yes
14614 Arguments :
14615 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14617 as explained at the top of this document.
14618
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014619 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14620 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14621 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014622
14623 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14624 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14625 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14626 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014627 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014628
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014629 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014630
14631
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014632timeout tunnel <timeout>
14633 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14635 yes | no | yes | yes
14636 Arguments :
14637 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14638 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14639 as explained at the top of this document.
14640
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014641 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014642 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14643 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14644 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014645 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14646 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014647 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14648 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14649 specified.
14650
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014651 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14652 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14653 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14654 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14655 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14656 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14657 state.
14658
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014659 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14660 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14661 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14662 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014663 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014664
14665 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14666 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14667 forget about it.
14668
14669 Example :
14670 defaults http
14671 option http-server-close
14672 timeout connect 5s
14673 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014674 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014675 timeout server 30s
14676 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14677
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014678 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014679
14680
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014681transparent (deprecated)
14682 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014684 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014685 Arguments : none
14686
14687 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14688 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14689 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14690 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14691 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14692 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14693 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14694 appropriate server.
14695
14696 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14697
14698 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14699 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14700
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014701 See also: "option transparent"
14702
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014703unique-id-format <string>
14704 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14706 yes | yes | yes | no
14707 Arguments :
14708 <string> is a log-format string.
14709
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014710 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14711 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14712 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14713 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014714
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014715 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014716 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014717 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14718 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14719 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14720 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14721 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14722 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014723
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014724 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14725 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014726
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014727 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014728
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014729 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014730
14731 will generate:
14732
14733 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14734
14735 See also: "unique-id-header"
14736
14737unique-id-header <name>
14738 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14740 yes | yes | yes | no
14741 Arguments :
14742 <name> is the name of the header.
14743
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014744 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14745 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014746
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014747 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014748
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014749 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014750 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14751
14752 will generate:
14753
14754 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14755
14756 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014757
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014758use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014759 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14761 no | yes | yes | no
14762 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014763 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14764 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014765
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014766 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14767 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014768
14769 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14770 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14771 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014772 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014774 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14775 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014776
14777 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14778 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14779 assign the backend.
14780
14781 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14782 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14783 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14784 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14785 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14786 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14787
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014788 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014789 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014790 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14791 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14792 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14793
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014794 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14795 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14796 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14797 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14798 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14799 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14800 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14801 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14802 cannot be forced from the request.
14803
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014804 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014805 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14806 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14807
14808 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14809 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014810
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014811use-fcgi-app <name>
14812 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14814 no | no | yes | yes
14815 Arguments :
14816 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14817
14818 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014819
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014820use-server <server> if <condition>
14821use-server <server> unless <condition>
14822 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14824 no | no | yes | yes
14825 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014826 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14827 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014828
14829 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14830
14831 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14832 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14833 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14834
14835 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14836 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14837 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14838 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14839 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14840 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14841 matches will assign the server.
14842
14843 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14844 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14845 with the next rules until one matches.
14846
14847 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14848 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14849 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14850 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14851
14852 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14853 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14854 stripped.
14855
14856 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14857 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014858 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014859 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014860 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014861
14862 Example :
14863 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014864 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014865 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014866 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014867 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014868 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014869 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014870 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14871 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14872
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014873 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14874 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14875 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14876 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014877 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014878 and we fall back to load balancing.
14879
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014880 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014881
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014882
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148835. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014884--------------------------
14885
14886The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14887depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14888settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14889written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14890described in this section.
14891
14892
148935.1. Bind options
14894-----------------
14895
14896The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14897as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14898no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14899parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14900while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14901provided immediately after the setting name.
14902
14903The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14904
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014905accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14906 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14907 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14908 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14909 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14910 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14911 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14912 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14913 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14914 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014915 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14916 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14917 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014919accept-proxy
14920 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014921 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14922 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014923 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14924 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14925 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14926 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014927 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014928 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14929 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014930 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14931 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014932
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014933allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014934 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014935 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014936 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014937 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14938 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014939
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014940alpn <protocols>
14941 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14942 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14943 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014944 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014945 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014946 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14947 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14948 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14949 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14950 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14951 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14952 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14953 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14954 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14955 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014956
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014957 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014958
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014959 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14960 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014961 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14962 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014963
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014964 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14965 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14966 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14967 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14968 globally.
14969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014970backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014971 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014972 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14973
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014974curves <curves>
14975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14976 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14977 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14978 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14979 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14980 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14981
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014982ecdhe <named curve>
14983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014984 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14985 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014986
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014987ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14989 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014990 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14991 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014992 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014993
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014994 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14995 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14996 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14997 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14998 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014999 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020015000
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015001ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
15002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15003 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015004 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15005 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15006 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15007 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15008 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015009 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15010 error is ignored.
15011
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015012ca-sign-file <cafile>
15013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15014 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
15015 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
15016 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15017 'generate-certificates' for details.
15018
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000015019ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
15021 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
15022 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15023 'generate-certificates' for details.
15024
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015025ca-verify-file <cafile>
15026 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
15027 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
15028 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
15029 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
15030 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
15031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015032ciphers <ciphers>
15033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15034 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000015035 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015036 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015037 information and recommendations see e.g.
15038 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15039 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15040 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
15041
15042ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15043 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15044 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010015045 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
15046 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
15047 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
15048 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
15049 This setting might accept TLSv1.2 ciphersuites however this is an
15050 undocumented behavior and not recommended as it could be inconsistent or buggy.
15051 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
15052 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
15053
15054 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
15055
15056 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
15057 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
15058 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
15059 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
15060 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
15061
15062 Example:
15063 ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
15064 ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015065
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020015066client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
15067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15068 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
15069 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
15070 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15071 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
15072
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015073crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15075 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020015076 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
15077 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015079crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15081 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
15082 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
15083 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
15084 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010015085 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
15086 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015087
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010015088 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
15089 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
15090
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015091 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
15092 are loaded.
15093
15094 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010015095 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020015096 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
15097 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
15098 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15099 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15100 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15101 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15102 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015103 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15104 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015105
15106 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15107 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15108 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15109 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015110 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15111 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015112
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015113 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015115 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015116 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015117 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15118 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015119 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15120 clients).
15121
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015122 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015123 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15124 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15125 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15126 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15127 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15128 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15129 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15130 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15131 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15132 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15133 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15134 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15135
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015136 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015137 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15138 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15139 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15140 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15141
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015142 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15143 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15144 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15145 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015146
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015147 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15148 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15149 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015150
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015151crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015153 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15154 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15155 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15156 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15157 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15158 in new version of OpenSSL.
15159 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15160 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015161
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015162crt-list <file>
15163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015164 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15165 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015166
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015167 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15168
William Lallemandb5a3d582024-05-21 17:49:58 +020015169 sslbindconf supports the following keywords from the bind line
15170 (see Section 5.1. Bind options):
15171
15172 - allow-0rtt
15173 - alpn
15174 - ca-file
15175 - ca-verify-file
15176 - ciphers
15177 - ciphersuites
15178 - client-sigalgs
15179 - crl-file
15180 - curves
15181 - ecdhe
15182 - no-alpn
15183 - no-ca-names
15184 - npn
15185 - sigalgs
15186 - ssl-min-ver
15187 - ssl-max-ver
15188 - verify
15189
15190 It overrides the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015191
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015192 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015193 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15194 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15195 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15196 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15197 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015198 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15199 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15200 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015201
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015202 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15203 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15204 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015205
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015206 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15207
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015208 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015209 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015210 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15211 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15212 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15213 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15214 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15215 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015216
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015217 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15218 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15219 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15220 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15221 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15222
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015223 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015224 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015225 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015226 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015227 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015228 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015230defer-accept
15231 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15232 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15233 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015234 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015235 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15236 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15237 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15238 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15239 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15240 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15241 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15242
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015243expose-fd listeners
15244 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15245 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015246 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15247 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015248 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015249
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015250force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015251 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015252 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015253 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015254 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015255
15256force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015257 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015258 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015259 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015260
15261force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015262 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015263 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015264 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015265
15266force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015267 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015268 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015269 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015270
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015271force-tlsv13
15272 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15273 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015274 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015275
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015276generate-certificates
15277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15278 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15279 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15280 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15281 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15282 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15283 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15284 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15285 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15286 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15287 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15288
15289 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15290 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015291 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015292 certificate is used many times.
15293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015294gid <gid>
15295 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15296 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15297 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15298 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15299 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15300
15301group <group>
15302 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15303 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15304 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15305 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15306 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15307
15308id <id>
15309 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15310 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15311 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15312 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15313
15314interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015315 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15316 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15317 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15318 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15319 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15320 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015321 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15322 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15323 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15324 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15325 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15326 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015327
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015328level <level>
15329 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15330 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15331 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015332 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015333 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15334 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15335 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015336 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015337 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015338 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015339 all counters).
15340
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015341severity-output <format>
15342 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15343 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15344 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15345 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15346 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15347 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15348 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15349 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15350 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15351 rfc5424 convention.
15352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015353maxconn <maxconn>
15354 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15355 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15356 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15357 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15358 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15359 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15360 eat all memory.
15361
15362mode <mode>
15363 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15364 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15365 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15366 UNIX sockets.
15367
15368mss <maxseg>
15369 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15370 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15371 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15372 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15373 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15374 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15375 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15376 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15377 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15378 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15379 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15380
15381name <name>
15382 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15383 page.
15384
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015385namespace <name>
15386 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15387 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15388 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15389 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015391nice <nice>
15392 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15393 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15394 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15395 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15396 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15397 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15398 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15399 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15400 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15401 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15402 one for an RDP socket.
15403
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015404no-alpn
15405 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15406 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15407 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015408 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15409 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15410 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15411 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15412 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015413
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015414no-ca-names
15415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15416 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015417 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015418
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015419no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015421 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015422 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015423 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015424 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15425 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015426
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015427no-tls-tickets
15428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15429 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15430 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015431 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15432 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015433 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15434 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15435 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015436
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015437no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015439 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015440 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015441 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015442 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15443 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015444
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015445no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015447 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015448 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015449 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015450 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15451 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015452
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015453no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015455 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015456 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015457 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015458 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15459 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015460
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015461no-tlsv13
15462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15463 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15464 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15465 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015466 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15467 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015468
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015469npn <protocols>
15470 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15471 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15472 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015473 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015474 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015475 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15476 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15477 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15478 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15479 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015480
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015481ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015482 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15483 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015484 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15485 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15486 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15487 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15488 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15489 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15490 configuration enabling it:
15491
15492 haproxy.cfg:
15493 frontend fe
15494 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15495
15496 haproxy.list:
15497 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15498
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015499 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15500 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15501 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15502 the OCSP certid to be built.
15503 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15504 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15505 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15506 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15507 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15508 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15509 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15510 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15511 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15512 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15513 short time after init.
15514 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15515 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015516 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15517 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15518 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015519 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15520
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015521 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15522 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15523 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15524 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15525 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15526 - a numerical update status
15527 - a textual update status
15528 - the number of update failures for the given response
15529 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015530 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015531 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15532 the concerned OCSP response update.
15533 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15534 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15535 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15536 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15537 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015538 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015539 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15540 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015541 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15542 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15543 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15544 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15545 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015546
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015547 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15548 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15549 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15550 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15551 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015552
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015553 Troubleshooting:
15554 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15555 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15556 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15557 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15558 section.
15559 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15560 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15561
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015562prefer-client-ciphers
15563 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15564 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15565 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015566 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15567 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15568 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015569
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015570proto <name>
15571 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15572 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15573 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015574 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15575 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15576
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015577 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15578 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15579 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015580
15581 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15582 a bind line :
15583
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015584 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015585 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15586 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15587
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015588 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015589 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015590 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015591 h2" on the bind line.
15592
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015593quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015594 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15595 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15596 to those used by TCP.
15597
15598 Default value: cubic
15599
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015600quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015601 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15602 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15603 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15604 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15605 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15606 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15607 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015608 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15609
15610 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15611 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015612
15613 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15614 information about QUIC retry.
15615
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015616shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015617 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15618 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15619 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15620 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15621 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15622 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15623 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15624 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15625 little bit.
15626
15627 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15628 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15629 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15630 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15631 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015632 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15633 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15634 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15635 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15636 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015637
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015638 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15639 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15640 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15641 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15642 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15643 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15644 listeners will not be the expected one.
15645
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015646sigalgs <sigalgs>
15647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15648 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15649 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15650 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15651 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15652 required.
15653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015654ssl
15655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015656 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015657 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15658 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015659 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15660 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015661
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015662ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15663 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015664 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15665 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15666 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015667 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15668
15669ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015670 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15671 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15672 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15673 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015674
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015675strict-sni
15676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15677 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015678 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15679 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15680 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15681 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15682 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015683
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015684tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015685 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015686 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015687 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015688 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015689 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15690 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15691 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15692 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15693 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15694 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15695 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15696
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015697tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015698 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015699 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15700 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15701 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15702 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15703 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15704 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15705 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015706 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15707 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15708 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015709
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015710thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015711 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15712 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15713 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015714
15715 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15716 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015717 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15718 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15719 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15720 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15721 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15722 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15723 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15724 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015725
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015726 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15727 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015728
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015729 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15730
15731 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15732 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15733 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15734 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15735 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15736 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15737 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015738 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015739 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15740 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15741 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15742 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15743
15744 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15745 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15746 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15747 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15748 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15749 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015750
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015751 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15752 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15753 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15754 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15755 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15756 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15757 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15758 "option socket-stats" is used.
15759
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015760 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15761 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15762 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15763 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015764 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15765 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015766
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015767tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15768 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015769 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15770 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15771 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15772 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15773 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15774 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15775 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15776 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15777 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15778 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015779 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15780 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015782transparent
15783 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15784 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15785 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15786 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15787 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15788 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15789 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15790 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15791 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15792 so check for support with your vendor.
15793
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015794v4v6
15795 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15796 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15797 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15798 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015799 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015800
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015801v6only
15802 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15803 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15804 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015805 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15806 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015807
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015808uid <uid>
15809 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15810 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15811 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15812 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15813 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15814
15815user <user>
15816 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15817 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15818 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15819 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15820 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15821
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015822verify [none|optional|required]
15823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15824 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15825 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15826 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15827 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015828 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15829 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15830 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15831 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200158335.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015834------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015836The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15837which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15838arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15839settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15840after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15841Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15842address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015844 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015845 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015846
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015847Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15848keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015850The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015851
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015852addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015853 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015854 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15855 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15856 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15857 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15858 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015859
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015860agent-check
15861 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015862 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015863 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15864 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15865 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015866
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015867 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015868 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015869 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015870 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15871 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015872
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015873 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15874 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15875 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15876 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15877 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015878
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015879 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015880 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015881
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015882 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15883 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15884 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015885
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015886 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15887 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15888 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015889
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015890 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015891 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15892 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15893 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15894 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015895 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015896 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015897
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015898 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15899 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015900
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015901 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15902 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15903 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15904 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15905 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15906 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15907 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15908 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15909 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015910
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015911 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15912 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015913 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15914 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15915 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015916 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015917
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015918 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015919 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015920
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015921agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015922 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015923 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15924 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15925 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15926 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15927
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015928agent-inter <delay>
15929 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15930 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15931
15932 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15933 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15934 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15935 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15936 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15937 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15938 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15939 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15940 of backends use the same servers.
15941
15942 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15943
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015944agent-addr <addr>
15945 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15946
15947 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015948 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015949 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15950 hostname, it will be resolved.
15951
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015952agent-port <port>
15953 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15954
15955 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15956
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015957allow-0rtt
15958 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015959 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15960 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015961
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015962alpn <protocols>
15963 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15964 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15965 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015966 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015967 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15968 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15969 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15970 now obsolete NPN extension.
15971 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15972 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15973
15974 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15975
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015976 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015978backup
15979 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15980 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15981 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15982 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015983 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15984 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015985
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015986ca-file <cafile>
15987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15988 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015989 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15990 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015991 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015992
15993 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15994 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15995 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015997check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015998 This option enables health checks on a server:
15999 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
16000 considered available.
16001 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
16002 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
16003 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
16004 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
16005 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016006 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
16007 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016008 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
16009 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
16010 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
16011 exchanges succeed.
16012
16013 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
16014 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
16015 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
16016 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
16017 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050016018 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016019 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
16020
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016021 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020016022 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016023 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
16024 not overridden.
16025
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016026 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
16027 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
16028
16029 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
16030 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
16031
16032 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
16033 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
16034 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
16035 available.
16036
16037 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
16038 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
16039 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
16040
16041 Example:
16042 # simple tcp check
16043 backend foo
16044 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
16045 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
16046 backend foo
16047 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
16048 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
16049 backend foo
16050 option tcp-check
16051 tcp-check connect
16052 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016053
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020016054check-send-proxy
16055 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
16056 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
16057 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
16058 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
16059 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
16060 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
16061 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
16062
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010016063check-alpn <protocols>
16064 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
16065 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
16066 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
16067
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016068check-proto <name>
16069 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
16070 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
16071 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016072 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
16073 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16074
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016075 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16076 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16077 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016078
16079 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
16080 directive on a server line:
16081
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016082 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016083 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16084 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16085 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16086
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016087 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016088 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
16089 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
16090
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016091check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016092 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016093 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
16094 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016095
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016096check-ssl
16097 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
16098 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
16099 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
16100 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016101 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016102 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
16103 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016105 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
16106 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016107
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016108check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016109 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016110 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
16111 for normal traffic.
16112
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016113ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
16115 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16116 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016117 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16118 information and recommendations see e.g.
16119 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16120 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16121 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016122
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016123ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16125 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010016126 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16127 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
16128 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16129 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16130 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016132cookie <value>
16133 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16134 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16135 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16136 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16137 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16138 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16139 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16140
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016141crl-file <crlfile>
16142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16143 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16144 to verify server's certificate.
16145
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016146crt <cert>
16147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16148 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16149 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16150 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16151 certificate request.
16152
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016153 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16154 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16155 option is set accordingly).
16156
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016157disabled
16158 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16159 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16160 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16161 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16162 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016163 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016164
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016165enabled
16166 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16167 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16168 default value.
16169 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16170 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016172error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016173 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16174 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16175 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016177 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016179fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016180 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16181 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16182 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16183
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016184force-sslv3
16185 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16186 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016187 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016188 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016189
16190force-tlsv10
16191 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016192 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016193 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016194
16195force-tlsv11
16196 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016197 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016198 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016199
16200force-tlsv12
16201 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016202 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016203 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016204
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016205force-tlsv13
16206 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16207 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016208 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016210id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016211 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16212 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16213 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016214
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016215init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16216 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16217 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016218 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016219 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16220 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16221 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16222 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16223 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16224 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16225 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16226 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16227 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016228 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016229 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16230 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16231 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16232 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16233 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16234 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016235 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016236
16237 Example:
16238 defaults
16239 # never fail on address resolution
16240 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016242inter <delay>
16243fastinter <delay>
16244downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016245 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16246 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16247 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16248 between checks depending on the server state :
16249
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016250 Server state | Interval used
16251 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16252 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16253 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16254 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16255 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16256 or yet unchecked. |
16257 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16258 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16259 | "inter" otherwise.
16260 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016262 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16263 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16264 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16265 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016266 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16267 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16268 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16269 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16270 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016271
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016272log-proto <logproto>
16273 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16274 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16275 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16276 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016278maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016279 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16280 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016281 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16282 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016283 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16284 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16285 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16286 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16287
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016288 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16289 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16290 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16291 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16292 than 50 concurrent requests.
16293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016294maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016295 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16296 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16297 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16298 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016299 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16300 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16301 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16302 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16303 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16304 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16305 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016306
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016307max-reuse <count>
16308 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16309 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16310 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16311 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16312 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16313 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16314 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16315 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016317minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016318 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16319 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16320 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16321 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16322 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16323 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016324 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016325 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016326
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016327namespace <name>
16328 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16329 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16330 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16331 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16332
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016333no-agent-check
16334 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16335 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16336 default value.
16337 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16338 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16339
16340no-backup
16341 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16342 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16343 default value.
16344 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16345 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16346
16347no-check
16348 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16349 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16350 default value.
16351 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16352 "default-server" "check" setting.
16353
16354no-check-ssl
16355 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16356 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16357 default value.
16358 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16359 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16360
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016361no-send-proxy
16362 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16363 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16364 default value.
16365 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16366 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16367
16368no-send-proxy-v2
16369 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16370 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16371 default value.
16372 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16373 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16374
16375no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16376 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16377 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16378 default value.
16379 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16380 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16381
16382no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16385 default value.
16386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16387 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16388
16389no-ssl
16390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16392 default value.
16393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16394 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16395
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016396 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16397 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16398 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16399
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016400no-ssl-reuse
16401 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16402 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16403 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16404 and for paranoid users.
16405
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016406no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016407 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16408 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016409 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016410
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016411 Supported in default-server: No
16412
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016413no-tls-tickets
16414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16415 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16416 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016417 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16418 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016419 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16420 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16421 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016422 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016423
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016424no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016425 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016426 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16427 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016428 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16429 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016430 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016431
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016432 Supported in default-server: No
16433
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016434no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016435 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016436 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16437 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016438 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16439 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016440 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016441
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016442 Supported in default-server: No
16443
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016444no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016445 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016446 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16447 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016448 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16449 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016450 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016451
16452 Supported in default-server: No
16453
16454no-tlsv13
16455 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16456 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16457 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16458 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16459 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016460 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016461
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016462 Supported in default-server: No
16463
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016464no-verifyhost
16465 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16466 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16467 default value.
16468 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16469 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016470
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016471no-tfo
16472 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16473 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16474 default value.
16475 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16476 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16477
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016478non-stick
16479 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16480 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16481 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16482
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016483npn <protocols>
16484 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16485 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16486 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016487 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016488 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16489 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16490 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016492observe <mode>
16493 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16494 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16495 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16496 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16497 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16498 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016499 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016500
16501 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016503on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016504 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16505 Currently, four modes are available:
16506 - fastinter: force fastinter
16507 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16508 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16509 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16510 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16511
16512 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16513
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016514on-marked-down <action>
16515 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16516 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016517 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16518 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16519 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16520 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16521 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16522 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16523 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16524 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016525
16526 Actions are disabled by default
16527
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016528on-marked-up <action>
16529 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16530 Currently one action is available:
16531 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16532 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16533 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16534 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016535 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16536 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016537 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16538 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16539
16540 Actions are disabled by default
16541
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016542pool-low-conn <max>
16543 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16544 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16545 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16546 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16547 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16548 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16549 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16550 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16551 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16552 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016553 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16554 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16555 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16556 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016557
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016558pool-max-conn <max>
16559 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16560 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16561 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16562 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16563 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16564 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16565
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016566pool-purge-delay <delay>
16567 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016568 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016569 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016571port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016572 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016573 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16574 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16575 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16576 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16577 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016578
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016579proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016580 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16581 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16582 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016583 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16584 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16585
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016586 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16587 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16588 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016589
16590 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16591 a server line :
16592
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016593 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016594 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16595 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16596 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16597
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016598 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016599 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16600
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016601 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016603redir <prefix>
16604 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16605 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16606 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16607 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16608 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16609 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16610 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16611 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016612 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016613 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016614 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16615 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16616 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16617 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16618
16619 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016621rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016622 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16623 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16624 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16625
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016626resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16627 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16628 server.
16629
16630 Available options:
16631
16632 * allow-dup-ip
16633 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16634 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16635 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16636 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16637 For such case, simply enable this option.
16638 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16639
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016640 * ignore-weight
16641 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16642 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16643 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16644
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016645 * prevent-dup-ip
16646 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16647 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16648 same fqdn.
16649 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16650
16651 Example:
16652 backend b_myapp
16653 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16654 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16655 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16656
16657 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16658 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16659 it
16660 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16661 different address
16662
16663 Default value: not set
16664
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016665resolve-prefer <family>
16666 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16667 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16668 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16669 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16670
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016671 Default value: ipv6
16672
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016673 Example:
16674
16675 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016676
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016677resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016678 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016679 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016680 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16682 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016683 configured network, another address is selected.
16684
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016685 Example:
16686
16687 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016688
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016689resolvers <id>
16690 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16691 hostname.
16692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016693 Example:
16694
16695 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016696
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016697 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016698
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016699send-proxy
16700 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16701 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16702 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16703 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016704 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16705 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16706 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16707 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016708 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016709 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16710 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16711 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16712 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16713 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016714 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16715 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016716
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016717send-proxy-v2
16718 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16719 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16720 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16721 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016722 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16723 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16724 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16725 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016726
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016727proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016728 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16729 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16730
16731 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16732 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16733 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16734 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16735 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16736 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16737 connection is supported).
16738 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16739 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16740 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16741 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16742 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16743 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16744 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016745
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016746send-proxy-v2-ssl
16747 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16748 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16749 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16750 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16751 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16752 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16753 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016754 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16755 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016756
16757send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16758 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16759 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16760 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16761 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16762 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16763 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16764 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16765 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016766 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16767 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016768
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016769shard <shard>
16770 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16771 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16772 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16773 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16774 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16775 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16776 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16777
16778 Example :
16779
16780 peers mypeers
16781 shards 3
16782 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16783 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16784 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16785 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16786
16787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016788slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016789 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16790 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16791 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16792 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16793 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16794 parameters :
16795
16796 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16797 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16798
16799 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16800 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16801 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16802 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16803
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016804 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016805 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16806 seen as failed.
16807
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016808sni <expression>
16809 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16810 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16811 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016812 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16813 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16814 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16815 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016816 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016817 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016818 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16819 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016820
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016821source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016822source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016823source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016824 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16825 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16826 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16827 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16828
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016829 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16830 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16831 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16832 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16833 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16834 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16835 server.
16836
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016837 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16838 specifying the source address without port(s).
16839
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016840ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016841 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16842 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16843 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16844 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16845 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16846 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016847 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16848 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016849
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016850ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16851 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16852 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16853 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16854
16855ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16856 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16857 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16858 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16859
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016860ssl-reuse
16861 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16862 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16863 default value.
16864 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16865 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16866
16867stick
16868 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16869 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16870 default value.
16871 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16872 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016873
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016874socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016875 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016876 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16877 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16878
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016879tcp-ut <delay>
16880 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016881 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016882 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016883 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016884 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16885 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16886 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16887 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16888 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16889 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16890 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16891 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16892 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16893
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016894tfo
16895 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16896 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16897 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16898 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016899 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016900 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016901
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016902track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016903 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16904 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16905 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016906 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016907 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16908
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016909tls-tickets
16910 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16911 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16912 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016913 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16914 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16915 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016916 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016917 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016918
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016919verify [none|required]
16920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016921 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016922 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16923 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016924 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016925 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16926 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16927 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16928 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16929 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16930 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16931 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16932 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016933
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016934verifyhost <hostname>
16935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016936 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16937 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16938 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16939 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16940 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16941 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16942 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16943 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016945weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016946 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16947 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16948 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016949 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16950 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16951 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16952 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16953 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16954 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016955
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016956ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16957 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16958 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16959 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16960
16961 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16962 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16963 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16964 server ALPN contains it.
16965
16966 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16967 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16968 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16969 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16970
16971 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16972 favor of the ALPN extension.
16973
16974 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016976
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169775.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16978-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016979
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016980HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16981using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016982configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016983This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16984can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16985workload.
16986This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16987resolution at run time.
16988Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16989carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16990
16991
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169925.3.1. Global overview
16993----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016994
16995As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16996different steps of the process life:
16997
16998 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16999 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
17000 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
17001
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017002 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
17003 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017004
17005A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
17006 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
17007 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
17008 resolution to know this new IP.
17009
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017010When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017011HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017012SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
17013from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017014will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017015will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020017016
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017017A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017018 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017019 first valid response.
17020
17021 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
17022 servers return an error.
17023
17024
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200170255.3.2. The resolvers section
17026----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017027
17028This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017029HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
17030contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017031
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020017032At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
17033no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
17034default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
17035failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
17036
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017037When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
17038uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
17039is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
17040answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
17041
17042When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017043used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017044
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017045 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
17046 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
17047 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017048
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017049 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
17050 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017051
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010017052 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017053 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
17054 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017055
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017056For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
17057following scenarios are possible:
17058
17059 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
17060 ignored
17061
17062 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
17063 applied
17064
17065 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
17066 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
17067
17068 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
17069 retries the query with a new type
17070
17071 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
17072 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017073
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017074As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017075a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017076<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017077
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017078
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017079resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017080 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017081
17082A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
17083
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017084accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017085 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017086 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017087 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
17088 by RFC 6891)
17089
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010017090 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
17091 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
17092 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
17093 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
17094 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
17095 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020017096
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017097nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
17098 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
17099 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
17100 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
17101 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
17102 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
17103 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
17104 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
17105 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
17106 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010017107 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
17108
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017109parse-resolv-conf
17110 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
17111 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
17112 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
17113
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017114hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017115 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17116 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17117 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17118 counteract the just received invalid status.
17119
17120 <status> : last name resolution status.
17121 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17122 status during the concluding period.
17123
17124 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17125 status during the concluding period.
17126
17127 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17128 valid status during the concluding period.
17129
17130 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17131 valid status during the concluding period.
17132
17133 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17134 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17135 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17136 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17137 dynamic resolution of servers.
17138
17139 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17140 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17141 applies to SRV records.
17142
17143 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17144 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17145 milliseconds by default.
17146
17147 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17148 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17149 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17150 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17151 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17152
17153 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17154 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17155 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17156 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17157
17158 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17159 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017160
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017161 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017162
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017163resolve_retries <nb>
17164 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17165 giving up.
17166 Default value: 3
17167
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017168 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17169 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17170 type.
17171
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017172timeout <event> <time>
17173 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17174 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17175 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017176 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17177 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017178 Default value: 1s
17179 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017180 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017181 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017182 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17183 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17184
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017185 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017186
17187 resolvers mydns
17188 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17189 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017190 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017191 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017192 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017193 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017194 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017195 hold other 30s
17196 hold refused 30s
17197 hold nx 30s
17198 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017199 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017200 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017201
17202
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200172036. Cache
17204---------
17205
17206HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17207(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17208RAM.
17209
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017210The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17211blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017212
17213If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17214independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17215when we try to allocate a new one.
17216
17217The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17218
17219It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17220"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17221for more details.
17222
17223When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17224replaced by "<CACHE>".
17225
17226
172276.1. Limitation
17228----------------
17229
17230The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17231
17232- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017233- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17234 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17235 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017236- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17237- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017238- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17239 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17240 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017241- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17242 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017243- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17244 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17245 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017246
17247- If the request is not a GET
17248- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17249- If the request contains an Authorization header
17250
17251
172526.2. Setup
17253-----------
17254
17255To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17256the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17257
17258
172596.2.1. Cache section
17260---------------------
17261
17262cache <name>
17263 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17264 size of cache is mandatory.
17265
17266total-max-size <megabytes>
17267 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17268 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17269
17270max-object-size <bytes>
17271 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17272 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17273 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17274
17275max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017276 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017277 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17278 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17279 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17280 default.
17281
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017282process-vary <on/off>
17283 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017284 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17285 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17286 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017287 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017288
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017289max-secondary-entries <number>
17290 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17291 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17292 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17293
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017294
172956.2.2. Proxy section
17296---------------------
17297
17298http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17299 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17300 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17301 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17302 after this one.
17303
17304http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17305 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17306 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17307 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17308 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17309
17310
17311Example:
17312
17313 backend bck1
17314 mode http
17315
17316 http-request cache-use foobar
17317 http-response cache-store foobar
17318 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17319
17320 cache foobar
17321 total-max-size 4
17322 max-age 240
17323
17324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200173257. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17326----------------------------------
17327
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017328HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17330The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17331these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17332but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17333data called patterns.
17334
17335
173367.1. ACL basics
17337---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017338
17339The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17340content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17341from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17342simple :
17343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017345 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017346 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17347 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17350adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017351
17352In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017355
17356This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17357Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17358and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017359an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17360conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17361as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17362are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017363
17364ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17365'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17366which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17367
17368There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17369performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17372specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17373this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017374methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17375ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376
17377Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17378 - boolean
17379 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17380 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17381 - string
17382 - data block
17383
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017384Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17385converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17386would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17387The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17388which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17389
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017390Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17391keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17392fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17393which are summarized in the table below :
17394
17395 +---------------------+-----------------+
17396 | Sample or converter | Default |
17397 | output type | matching method |
17398 +---------------------+-----------------+
17399 | boolean | bool |
17400 +---------------------+-----------------+
17401 | integer | int |
17402 +---------------------+-----------------+
17403 | ip | ip |
17404 +---------------------+-----------------+
17405 | string | str |
17406 +---------------------+-----------------+
17407 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17408 +---------------------+-----------------+
17409
17410Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17411matching method, see below.
17412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17414 - boolean
17415 - integer or integer range
17416 - IP address / network
17417 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17418 - regular expression
17419 - hex block
17420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017421The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17422
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017423 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17424 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017426 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017427 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017428 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017429 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17432read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17433if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17434lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17435will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17436beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017437a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17439exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17440
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017441The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17442parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17443ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17444a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17445check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17446
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017447The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17448socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17449file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17452loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17453
17454 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17455
17456In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17457the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17458case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17459as well.
17460
17461The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17462sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17463do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17464methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17465is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017466obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017467followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17468default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17469that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17470string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17471
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017472The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17473By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17474string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17475resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017476server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017477waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017478flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17479function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017481There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17482sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17483be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017484
17485 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17486 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017487 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17488 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17489 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17490 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017491
17492 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17493 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017494 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017495
17496 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017498
17499 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017502 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017503 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17504
17505 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17506 binary or string samples.
17507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17509 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17512 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17513 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17516 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017518 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17519 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17522 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17525 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017526 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17529 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17530 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017531
17532For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17533request, it is possible to do :
17534
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017535 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017536
17537In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17538buffer, one would use the following acl :
17539
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017540 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017541
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017542On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17543possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17544
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017545 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17548criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17549method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017550to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17551usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17552converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17553method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17554matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17556the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017559the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17560For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17563 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17564 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17565 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017566
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017567
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017568The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17569types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17570combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17571brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17572default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574 +-------------------------------------------------+
17575 | Input sample type |
17576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017577 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17579 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017581 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017583 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017585 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017587 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017589 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017591 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017593 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017595 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017597 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017599 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017601 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017602 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17603 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17604 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017605
17606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176077.1.1. Matching booleans
17608------------------------
17609
17610In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17611Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17612When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17613that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17614
17615Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17616return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17617"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176207.1.2. Matching integers
17621------------------------
17622
17623Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17624enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17625to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17626
17627Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17628matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17629lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017630
17631For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17632unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17633representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17634
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017635As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17636two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17637instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17638ranges and operators.
17639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017640For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017641operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17642Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17643of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017645Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017646
17647 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17648 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17649 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17650 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17651 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017653For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017654
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017655 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017656
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017657This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17658
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017659 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176627.1.3. Matching strings
17663-----------------------
17664
17665String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17666different forms :
17667
17668 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017669 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670
17671 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017672 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673
17674 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17675 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17676
17677 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17678 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17679
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017680 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17681 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17682 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17683 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17684 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17685 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017686
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017687 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17688 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17689 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17690 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17691 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17692 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17693 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17694 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17695 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17696 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17697 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017698
17699String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17700exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17701characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17702string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17703to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017704before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017705
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017706Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17707(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17708Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17709
17710Example:
17711 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17712 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17716---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017717
17718Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17719they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17720possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17721passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17722the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017723the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17724match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017725
17726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17728-------------------------------------
17729
17730It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17731not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17732a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17733to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17734digits may be used upper or lower case.
17735
17736Example :
17737 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017738 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739
17740
177417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17742---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017743
17744IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17745netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17746within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017747host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017748difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17749at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17750does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17751parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017752
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017753The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17754abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17755
17756 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17757 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17758 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17759 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17760 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17761 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17762 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17763 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17764
17765Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17766192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17767
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017768IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17769Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17770trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17771IPv6 patterns.
17772
17773HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17774following situations :
17775 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17776 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17777 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17778 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17779 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17780 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17781 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17782 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17783 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17784 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786
177877.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17788----------------------------------
17789
17790Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17791combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17792
17793 - AND (implicit)
17794 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17795 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017797A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017799 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17802indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017804For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17805"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17806requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17807is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17808
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017809 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017810 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17811 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17812 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813
17814To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17815and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17816
17817 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17818 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17819 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17820 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017822 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017823 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17824 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17825 use_backend www if host_www
17826
17827It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17828expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17829be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17830the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17831
17832 The following rule :
17833
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017834 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017835 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836
17837 Can also be written that way :
17838
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017839 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840
17841It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17842to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17843simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17844sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17845good use is the following :
17846
17847 With named ACLs :
17848
17849 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17850 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17851 monitor fail if site_dead
17852
17853 With anonymous ACLs :
17854
17855 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17856
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017857See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17858keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859
17860
178617.3. Fetching samples
17862---------------------
17863
17864Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17865against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17866sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17867ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17868of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17869available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17870
17871This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17872Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17873compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17874deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17875
17876The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17877matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17878method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17879indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17880
17881As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17882when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17883mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17884the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17885ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17886
17887Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17888multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17889when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017890incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17891are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17893all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17894
17895Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17896 - name
17897 - name(arg1)
17898 - name(arg1,arg2)
17899
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017900
179017.3.1. Converters
17902-----------------
17903
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017904Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17905of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17906is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17907was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017908has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017909unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17910
17911These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17912sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17913the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017914support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017915
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017916A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17917support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17918supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17919(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17920bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017923
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001792451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17925 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17926 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17927 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17928 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17929 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17930
17931 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017932 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17933 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017934 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17935 frontend http-in
17936 bind *:8081
17937 default_backend servers
17938 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17939 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17940
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017941rfc7239_is_valid
17942 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17943 otherwise.
17944
17945 Example:
17946 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17947 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17948 # output: TRUE
17949 #input: "proto=custom"
17950 # output: FALSE
17951
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017952rfc7239_field(<field>)
17953 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17954
17955 Supported fields are:
17956 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17957 - host: http compliant host
17958 - for: RFC7239 node
17959 - by: RFC7239 node
17960
17961 More info here:
17962 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17963
17964 Example:
17965 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17966 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17967 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17968 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17969
17970 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17971 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17972 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17973 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17974
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017975rfc7239_n2nn
17976 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17977 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17978 - ipv4 address
17979 - ipv6 address
17980 - 'unknown'
17981 - '_obfs' identifier
17982
17983 Example:
17984 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17985 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17986 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017987 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17988 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17989 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17990 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17991 #input: "_name:_port"
17992 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017993
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017994rfc7239_n2np
17995 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17996 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17997 - unsigned integer
17998 - '_obfs' identifier
17999
18000 Example:
18001 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
18002 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
18003 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020018004 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020018005 # output: 9999 (integer)
18006 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
18007 # output: 9998 (integer)
18008 #input: "_name:_port"
18009 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010018010
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018011add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018012 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018013 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018014 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18015 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018016 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018017 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18018 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18019 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018022 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018023
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018024add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
18025 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
18026 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
18027 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
18028 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
18029 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18030 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
18031 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
18032 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
18033 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
18034 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
18035 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
18036 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
18037 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
18038 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
18039 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
18040 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
18041 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010018042 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
18043 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018044
18045 Example:
18046 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
18047 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
18048 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
18049 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
18050
18051 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
18052 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
18053
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010018054aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
18055 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
18056 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
18057 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
18058 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
18059 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
18060 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
18061
18062 Example:
18063 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
18064 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
18065
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018066and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018067 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018068 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018069 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18070 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018071 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018072 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18073 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18075 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018077 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018078
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018079b64dec
18080 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
18081 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018082 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
18083 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018084
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018085base64
18086 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018088 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
18089 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018090
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020018091be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
18092 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
18093 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
18094 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
18095 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
18096 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
18097
18098 Example:
18099 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
18100 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
18101 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
18102 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
18103
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020018104be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
18105 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
18106 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
18107 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
18108 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
18109 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
18110 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
18111
18112 Example:
18113 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
18114 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
18115 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18116 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018118bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018119 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018120 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018121 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018122 presence of a flag).
18123
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018124bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18125 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18126 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018127 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018128
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018129concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18130 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18131 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18132 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18133 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18134 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18135 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18136 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18137 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18138 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18139 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018140 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018141 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018142 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018143 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18144 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18145 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018146
18147 Example:
18148 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18149 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18150 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018151 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018152 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018153 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18154
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018155cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018156 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18157 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018158
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018159crc32([<avalanche>])
18160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18161 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18162 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18163 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18164 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18165 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18166 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18167 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18168 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18169 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018170 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18171
18172crc32c([<avalanche>])
18173 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18174 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18175 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18176 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18177 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18178 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18179 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18180 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018181
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018182cut_crlf
18183 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18184 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18185 updated.
18186
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018187da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018188 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18189 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18190 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18191 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018192 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018193 configuration language.
18194
18195 Example:
18196 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018197 bind *:8881
18198 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018199 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018200
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018201debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18202 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18203 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18204 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18205 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18206 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18207 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18208 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18209 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18210 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18211 printable sample types.
18212
18213 Example:
18214 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018215
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018216digest(<algorithm>)
18217 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18218 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18219
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018220 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018221 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18222
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018223div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018224 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18225 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018226 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018227 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18228 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018229 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018230 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18231 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18232 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18233 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018235 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018236
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018237djb2([<avalanche>])
18238 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18239 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18240 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18241 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18242 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18243 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18244 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018245 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18246 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018247
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018248even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018249 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018250 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18251
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018252field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18253 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18254 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18255 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18256 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18257 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18258 fields.
18259
18260 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018261 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018262 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18263 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018267
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018268fix_is_valid
18269 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18270 Information eXchange):
18271
18272 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18273 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018274 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018275 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018276 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018277 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18278 checksum
18279
18280 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18281 the server can be parsed.
18282
18283 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18284 message, false if not.
18285
18286 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18287
18288 Example:
18289 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18290 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18291
18292fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18293 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18294 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18295 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18296 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018297 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018298 added.
18299
18300 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18301 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18302 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18303 fix_is_valid converter.
18304
18305 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18306
18307 Example:
18308 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18309 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18310 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18311 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18312 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018314hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018315 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018316 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018317 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018318 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018319
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018320hex2i
18321 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018322 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018323
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018324htonl
18325 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18326 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18327 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18328 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18329
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018330hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018331 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18332 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18333 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18334 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18335
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018336 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018337 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18338
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018339host_only
18340 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18341 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18342 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18343 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18344
18345 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18346
18347 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18348
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018349http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018350 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18351 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018352 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18353 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18354 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18355 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18356 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18357 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18358 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18359 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018361iif(<true>,<false>)
18362 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18363 string otherwise.
18364
18365 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018366 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018367
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018368in_table(<table>)
18369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18371 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018372 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018373 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18374
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018375ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018376 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018377 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018378 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18379 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18380 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18381 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18382 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018383
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018384json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018385 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018386 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018387 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018388 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18389 of errors:
18390 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18391 bytes, ...)
18392 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18393 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18394
18395 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18396 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18397 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18398 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18399 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18400 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018401 - "ascii" : never fails;
18402 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18403 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018404 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018405 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018406 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18407 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18408
18409 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018410 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018411
18412 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018413 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018414 capture request header user-agent len 150
18415 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018416
18417 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18418 GET / HTTP/1.0
18419 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18420
18421 Output log:
18422 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18423
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018424json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18425 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18426 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18427 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18428 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18429
18430 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18431 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18432
18433 Example:
18434 # get a integer value from the request body
18435 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18436 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18437
18438 # get a key with '.' in the name
18439 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18440 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18441
18442 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18443 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18444
18445 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18446 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18447
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018448jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18449 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18450 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18451 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18452 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18453 json_path and output_type parameters.
18454
18455 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18456 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18457
18458jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18459 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18460 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18461 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18462 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18463 json_path and output_type parameters.
18464
18465 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18466 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18467
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018468jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18469 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18470 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018471 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018472 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18473 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18474 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18475 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018476
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018477 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018478 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018479 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18480 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018481
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018482 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18483 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18484 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18485 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18486 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18487 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018488 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018489 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18490
18491 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18492 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18493 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18494 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18495 contents.
18496
18497 The possible return values are the following :
18498
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018499 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18500 | ID | message |
18501 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018502 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018503 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018504 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018505 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018506 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18507 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18508 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018509 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018510
18511 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18512 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18513
18514 Example:
18515 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18516 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18517 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18518 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018519 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018520 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018522language(<value>[,<default>])
18523 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18524 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18525 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18526 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18527 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18528 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18529 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18530 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18531 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018532 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018533 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18534 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018535
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018536 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018538 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18539 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018540
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018541 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18542 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18543 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18544 use_backend spanish if es
18545 use_backend french if fr
18546 use_backend english if en
18547 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018548
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018549length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018550 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18551 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18552 type. The result is of type integer.
18553
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018554lower
18555 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18556 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18557 type. The result is of type string.
18558
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018559ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18560 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18561 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18562 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18563 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18564 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18565 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18566
18567 Example :
18568
18569 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018570 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018571 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18572
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018573ltrim(<chars>)
18574 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18575 representation of the input sample.
18576
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018577map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18578map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18579map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18580 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18581 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18582 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18583 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18584 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18585 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18586 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18587 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018588
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018589 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18590 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18591 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018592
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018593 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018594 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018595
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018596 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18598 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018600 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018602 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18603 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18604 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18605 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18606 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18607 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18608 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18609 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018610 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18611 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18612 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018613 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18614 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18615 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18616 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18617 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018618
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018619 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18620 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18621 the corresponding match text.
18622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018623 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18624 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18625 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18626 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18627 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018628
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018629 Example :
18630
18631 # this is a comment and is ignored
18632 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18633 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18634 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18635 | | | `---------- value
18636 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18637 | `---------------------------- key
18638 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18639
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018640mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018641 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18642 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018643 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018644 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018645 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018646 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18647 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018651 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018652
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018653mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018654 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18655 <packettype>.
18656 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18657 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18658 from.
18659 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18660 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18661 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18662
18663 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18664 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18665 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18666 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18667
18668 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18669 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18670 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18671 packets only):
18672 17: Session Expiry Interval
18673 33: Receive Maximum
18674 39: Maximum Packet Size
18675 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18676 25: Request Response Information
18677 23: Request Problem Information
18678 21: Authentication Method
18679 22: Authentication Data
18680 18: Will Delay Interval
18681 1: Payload Format Indicator
18682 2: Message Expiry Interval
18683 3: Content Type
18684 8: Response Topic
18685 9: Correlation Data
18686 Not supported yet:
18687 38: User Property
18688
18689 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18690 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18691 packets only):
18692 17: Session Expiry Interval
18693 33: Receive Maximum
18694 36: Maximum QoS
18695 37: Retain Available
18696 39: Maximum Packet Size
18697 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18698 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18699 31: Reason String
18700 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18701 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18702 42: Shared Subscription Available
18703 19: Server Keep Alive
18704 26: Response Information
18705 28: Server Reference
18706 21: Authentication Method
18707 22: Authentication Data
18708 Not supported yet:
18709 38: User Property
18710
18711 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18712 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18713 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18714 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18715
18716 Example:
18717
18718 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18719 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18720 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18721 if data_in_buffer
18722 # do the same as above
18723 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18724 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18725 if data_in_buffer
18726
18727mqtt_is_valid
18728 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18729
18730 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18731 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18732 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18733 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18734
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018735 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18736
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018737 Example:
18738
18739 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018740 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018741
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018742mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018743 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018744 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18745 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018746 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018747 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018755
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018756nbsrv
18757 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18758 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18759 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18760 map lookup.
18761
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018762neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018763 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18764 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18765 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18766 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018767
18768not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018769 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018770 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018771 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018772 absence of a flag).
18773
18774odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018775 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018776 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18777
18778or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018779 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018780 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018781 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18782 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018783 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018784 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18785 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18786 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18787 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018788 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018789 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018790
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018791param(<name>,[<delim>])
18792 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18793 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18794 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18795 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18796 a value of an empty string.
18797
18798 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18799 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18800 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18801 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18802
18803 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18804 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18805 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18806 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18807 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18808 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18809
18810 Example :
18811 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18812 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18813 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18814 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18815 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18816
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018817port_only
18818 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18819 returning its port.
18820 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18821 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18822 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18823
18824 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18825
18826 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18827
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018828protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18829 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18830 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18831 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18832 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18833 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18834 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18835 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18836 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18837 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18838 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18839 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18840
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018841regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018842 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18843 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18844 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18845 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18846 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18847 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18848 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18849 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18850 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018851 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18852 of characters with other ones.
18853
18854 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18855 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18856 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18857 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18858 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18859 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018860
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018861 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018862
18863 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18864 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18865 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018866 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018867
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018868 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18869 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18870
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018871 # capture groups and backreferences
18872 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018873 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018874 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18875
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018876capture-req(<id>)
18877 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18878 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18879
18880 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018881 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18882 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018883
18884capture-res(<id>)
18885 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18886 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18887
18888 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018889 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18890 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018891
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018892rtrim(<chars>)
18893 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18894 of the input sample.
18895
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018896sdbm([<avalanche>])
18897 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18898 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18899 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18900 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18901 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18902 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18903 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018904 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18905 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018906
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018907secure_memcmp(<var>)
18908 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18909 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18910 match.
18911
18912 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18913 performed in constant time.
18914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018915 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018916 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18917
18918 Example :
18919
18920 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18921 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18922 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18923 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18924
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018925set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018926 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018927 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18928 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18929 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18930 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018931 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018932 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18933 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018934 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018935 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18936 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018937 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018938 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018940 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18941 possible conditions :
18942 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18943 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18944 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18945 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18946 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18947 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18948 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18949 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18950 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18951 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18952 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18953 called on the variable.
18954 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18955 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18956 configuration parsing.
18957 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18958 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18959 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18960 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18961 true by default.
18962
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018963sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018964 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018965 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18966
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018967sha2([<bits>])
18968 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18969 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18970
18971 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18972 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18973
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018974 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018975 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18976
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018977srv_queue
18978 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18979 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18980 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18981 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18982 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18983
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018984strcmp(<var>)
18985 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18986 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18987 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18988 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18989 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18990 shorter).
18991
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018992 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18993 strings in constant time.
18994
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018995 Example :
18996
18997 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18998 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18999 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
19000
19001
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019002sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019003 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
19004 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019005 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019006 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
19007 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019008 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019009 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19010 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019011 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019012 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19013 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019014 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019015 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019016
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019017table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
19018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
19021 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19022 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19023 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
19024
19025
19026table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
19027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
19030 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19031 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19032 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
19033
19034table_conn_cnt(<table>)
19035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019038 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
19039 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19040
19041table_conn_cur(<table>)
19042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19044 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19045 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19046 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
19047
19048table_conn_rate(<table>)
19049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
19052 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19053 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
19054
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019055table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
19056 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19057 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19058 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19059 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
19060 input sample in the designated table.
19061 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
19062
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019063table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
19064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
19067 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
19068 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19069 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19070 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
19071 data-type).
19072 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19073
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019074table_gpt0(<table>)
19075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19078 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19079 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
19080
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019081table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
19082 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19083 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19084 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
19085 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
19086 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
19087 between 0 and 99.
19088 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19089 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19090 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19091 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
19092
19093table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
19094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
19097 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
19098 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
19099 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19100 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
19101 value 0.
19102 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
19103 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19104 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
19105
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019106table_gpc0(<table>)
19107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19110 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19111 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
19112
19113table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
19114 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19115 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19116 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19117 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19118 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19119 sample fetch keyword.
19120
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019121table_gpc1(<table>)
19122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19124 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19125 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19126 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19127
19128table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19129 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19130 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19131 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19132 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19133 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19134 sample fetch keyword.
19135
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019136table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019139 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019140 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19141 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19142
19143table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19144 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19145 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19146 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19147 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19148 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19149 keyword.
19150
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019151table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19152 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19153 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19154 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19155 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19156 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19157
19158table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19161 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19162 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19163 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19164 keyword.
19165
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019166table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19167 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19168 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019169 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019170 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19171 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19172
19173table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19174 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19175 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19176 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19177 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19178 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19179 keyword.
19180
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019181table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019182 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19183 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19184 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19185 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19186 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19187 updated.
19188 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19189
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019190table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19191 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19192 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019193 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019194 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19195 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19196 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19197 keyword.
19198
19199table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19200 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19201 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019202 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019203 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19204 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19205 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19206 keyword.
19207
19208table_server_id(<table>)
19209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19212 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19213 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19214 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19215
19216table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19217 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19218 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019219 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019220 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19221 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19222 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19223 keyword.
19224
19225table_sess_rate(<table>)
19226 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19227 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19228 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19229 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19230 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19231 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19232 keyword.
19233
19234table_trackers(<table>)
19235 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19236 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19237 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19238 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19239 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19240 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19241 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19242 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19243 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19244 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19245
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019246ub64dec
19247 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19248 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19249 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19250
19251 Example:
19252 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19253 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19254
19255ub64enc
19256 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19257
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019258upper
19259 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19260 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19261 type. The result is of type string.
19262
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019263url_dec([<in_form>])
19264 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19265 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19266 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19267 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19268 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19269 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019270
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019271url_enc([<enc_type>])
19272 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19273 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19274 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19275 optional argument is here for future changes.
19276
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019277ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019278 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019279 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19280 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19281 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019282 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19283 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19284 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19285 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019286 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019287 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19288 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019289
19290 Example:
19291 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19292 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19293
19294 message Point {
19295 int32 latitude = 1;
19296 int32 longitude = 2;
19297 }
19298
19299 message PPoint {
19300 Point point = 59;
19301 }
19302
19303 message Rectangle {
19304 // One corner of the rectangle.
19305 PPoint lo = 48;
19306 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19307 PPoint hi = 49;
19308 }
19309
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019310 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19311 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19312 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019313
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019314 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19315 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019316 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019317 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19318
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019319 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019320
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019321 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019322
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019323 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19324 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19325 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019326
19327 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19328 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19329 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19330
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019331 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19332 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19333 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019334
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019335
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019336unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019337 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19338 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19339 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19340 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19341 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19342 response),
19343 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19344 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19345 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19346 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19347
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019348utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19349 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19350 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19351 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19352 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19353 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19354 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19355
19356 Example :
19357
19358 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019360 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19361
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019362word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19363 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19364 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19365 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019366 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19367 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19368 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019369 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19370 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19371
19372 Example :
19373 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019374 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019375 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19376 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19377 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19378 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019379 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019380 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019381
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019382wt6([<avalanche>])
19383 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19384 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19385 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19386 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19387 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19388 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19389 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019390 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19391 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019393xor(<value>)
19394 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019395 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019396 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019397 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019398 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019399 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19400 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019401 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019402 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19403 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019405 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019406
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019407xxh3([<seed>])
19408 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19409 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19410 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19411 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19412 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19413 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19414 considered as cryptographically secure.
19415
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019416xxh32([<seed>])
19417 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19418 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19419 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19420 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19421 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19422 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19423 as cryptographically secure.
19424
19425xxh64([<seed>])
19426 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19427 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19428 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19429 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19430 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19431 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19432 as cryptographically secure.
19433
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019434x509_v_err_str
19435 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19436 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19437 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19438
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019439 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19440 value as a string.
19441
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019442 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19443 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19444 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19445
19446 Example:
19447
19448 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19449
19450 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19451 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19452 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19453
19454 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19455 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19456 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019457
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019458 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19459
19460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200194617.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462--------------------------------------------
19463
19464A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19465not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019466"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019467The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19468
19469always_false : boolean
19470 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19471 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19472
19473always_true : boolean
19474 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19475 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19476
19477avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019478 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19480 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19481 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19482 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19483 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19484 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19485 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19486 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19487 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19488 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19489 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19490 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19491 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019493be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019494 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19495 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19496 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19497 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019498 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19499
19500be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19501 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19502 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19503 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19504 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19505 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019506 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19507 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019508
19509 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19510 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19511 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019513be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19514 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19515 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19516 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019517 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019518 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19519 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019520
19521 Example :
19522 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19523 backend dynamic
19524 mode http
19525 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19526 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019527
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019528bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019529 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19530 of the string.
19531
19532bool(<bool>) : bool
19533 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19534 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019536connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019538 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19540 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019541
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019542 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019543 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019544 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19545
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019546 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19547 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019548
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019549 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019550 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019552 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019553 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019555 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019556
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019557 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19558 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019560 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019561
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019562cpu_calls : integer
19563 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19564 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19565 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19566 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19567 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19568 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19569
19570cpu_ns_avg : integer
19571 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19572 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19573 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19574 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19575 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19576 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19577 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19578 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19579 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19580 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19581 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19582
19583cpu_ns_tot : integer
19584 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19585 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19586 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19587 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19588 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19589 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19590 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19591 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19592 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19593 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19594 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19595 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19596 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19597
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019598date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019599 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019600
19601 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19602 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19603 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019604 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19605
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019606 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19607 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19608 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19609 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19610 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19611
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019612 Example :
19613
19614 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19615 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019616
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019617 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19618 # millisecond granularity
19619 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19620
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019621date_us : integer
19622 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19623 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19624 from the same timeval structure.
19625
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019626env(<name>) : string
19627 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19628 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19629 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19630 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19631 certain way.
19632
19633 Examples :
19634 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19635 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19636
19637 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019638 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19641 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019642 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19643 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19645 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019646 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19648 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019649
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019650fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19652 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19653 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019655fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19657 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19658 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19659 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19660 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19661 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19662 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19663 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019664
19665 Example :
19666 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19667 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19668 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19669 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19670 frontend mail
19671 bind :25
19672 mode tcp
19673 maxconn 100
19674 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19675 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19676 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19677 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019678
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019679hostname : string
19680 Returns the system hostname.
19681
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019682int(<integer>) : signed integer
19683 Returns a signed integer.
19684
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019685ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19686 Returns an ipv4.
19687
19688ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19689 Returns an ipv6.
19690
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019691last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019692 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19693 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19694 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19695 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19696 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19697 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19698 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19699 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19700 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19701 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19702 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19703 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19704
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019705last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019706 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19707 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19708 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19709 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19710 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19711 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19712 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19713 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19714 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19715 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19716 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19717 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19718
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019719lat_ns_avg : integer
19720 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19721 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19722 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19723 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19724 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19725 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19726 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19727 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19728 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019729 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19730 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19731 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19732 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19733 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19734 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019735
19736lat_ns_tot : integer
19737 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19738 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19739 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19740 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19741 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19742 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19743 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19744 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19745 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019746 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19747 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19748 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19749 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19750 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019751 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19752 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19753 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19754 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19755 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19756 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19757
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019758meth(<method>) : method
19759 Returns a method.
19760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19763 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19764 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019765 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19766 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19767 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019768
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019769prio_class : integer
19770 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19771 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19772 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19773
19774prio_offset : integer
19775 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19776 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19777 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19778 set-priority-offset".
19779
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019780proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019781 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19782 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019785 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19786 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19787 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19789 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19790 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19791 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19792 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19793
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019794quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019795 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19796 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19797 global option.
19798
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019799rand([<range>]) : integer
19800 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19801 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19802 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19803 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19804 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019806srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19807 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19808 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19809 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19810 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19811 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019812 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19813 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19814
19815srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19817 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19818 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19819 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19820 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19821 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19822 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19823
19824 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19825 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019826
19827srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19828 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19829 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19830 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019831 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019832 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19833 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19834 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19835
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019836srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19837 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19838 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19839 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19840 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19841 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19842 fetch methods.
19843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019844srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19845 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19846 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019847 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19849 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019850 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019851 overloading servers).
19852
19853 Example :
19854 # Redirect to a separate back
19855 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19856 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19857 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19858
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019859srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019860 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19861 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19862 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19863
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019864srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019865 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19866 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19867 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19868
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019869srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019870 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19871 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19872 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19873
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019874stopping : boolean
19875 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19876 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19877 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19878
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019879str(<string>) : string
19880 Returns a string.
19881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019882table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19883 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19884 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19885
19886table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19887 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19888 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19889 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19890
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019891thread : integer
19892 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19893 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19894 and debugging purposes.
19895
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019896uuid([<version>]) : string
19897 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19898 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19899 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19900
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019901var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019902 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019903 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19904 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19905 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019906 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019907 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19908 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019909 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019910 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19911 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019912 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019913 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019914
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199157.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916----------------------------------
19917
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019918The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019919closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19920methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19921sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19922TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019923the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19924counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019925"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019926used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19927counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19928"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19929An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19930currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19931the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019933bc_dst : ip
19934 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19935 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19936 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19937 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19938
19939bc_dst_port : integer
19940 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019941 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019942
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019943bc_err : integer
19944 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19945 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19946 and their corresponding error message.
19947
19948bc_err_str : string
19949 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19950 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19951 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19952 corresponding error message.
19953
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010019954bc_glitches : integer
19955 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the backend connection.
19956 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
19957 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving server that may cause trouble in
19958 the infrastructure (e.g. cause connections to be aborted early, inducing
19959 frequent TLS renegotiations). These may also be caused by too large responses
19960 that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining HTTP 502 errors. Ideally
19961 this number should remain zero, though it's generally fine if it remains very
19962 low compared to the total number of requests. These values should normally
19963 not be considered as alarming (especially small ones), though a sudden jump
19964 may indicate an anomaly somewhere. Not all protocol multiplexers measure this
19965 metric and the only way to get more details about the events is to enable
19966 traces to capture all exchanges.
19967
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019968bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019969 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19970 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19971 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19972
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019973bc_src : ip
19974 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019975 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019976 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19977 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19978
19979bc_src_port : integer
19980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019981 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019983be_id : integer
19984 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019985 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19986 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019987
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019988be_name : string
19989 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019990 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19991 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019992
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019993bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19994 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19995 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19996 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19997 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19998 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19999 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20000
20001bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20002 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20003 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20004 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20005 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20006 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20007 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20008
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010020009be_server_timeout : integer
20010 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
20011 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20012 also the "cur_server_timeout".
20013
20014be_tunnel_timeout : integer
20015 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
20016 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20017 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
20018
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010020019cur_server_timeout : integer
20020 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20021 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
20022 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
20023
20024cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
20025 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20026 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
20027 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
20028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020029dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020030 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
20031 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
20032 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
20033 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
20034 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
20035 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
20036 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
20037 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
20038 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
20039 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
20040 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020041
20042dst_conn : integer
20043 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
20044 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
20045 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
20046 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
20047 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
20048 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
20049 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
20050 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020051
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020052dst_is_local : boolean
20053 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
20054 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
20055 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
20056 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020057 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020058 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
20059 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
20060 it only once per connection.
20061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020062dst_port : integer
20063 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
20064 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020065 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
20066 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
20067 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
20068 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020069
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020070fc_dst : ip
20071 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
20072 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
20073 for details.
20074
20075fc_dst_is_local : boolean
20076 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
20077 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
20078 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
20079
20080fc_dst_port : integer
20081 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
20082 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
20083 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
20084
20085fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020086 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
20087 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
20088 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020089 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020090 error codes and their corresponding error message.
20091
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020092fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050020093 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020094 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020095 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020096 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
20097
20098 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20099 | ID | message |
20100 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20101 | 0 | "Success" |
20102 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
20103 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
20104 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
20105 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
20106 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
20107 | 6 | "General socket error" |
20108 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
20109 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
20110 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
20111 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
20112 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20113 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20114 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20115 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
20116 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
20117 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
20118 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
20119 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20120 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20121 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
20122 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
20123 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
20124 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
20125 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
20126 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
20127 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
20128 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
20129 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20130 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20131 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20132 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20133 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20134 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20135 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20136 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20137 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20138 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20139 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20140 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20141 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20142 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20143 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020144 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020145 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20146
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020147fc_fackets : integer
20148 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20149 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20150 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20151 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20152
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010020153fc_glitches : integer
20154 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the frontend connection.
20155 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
20156 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving client that may cause trouble in
20157 the infrastructure, such as excess of errors in the logs, or many connections
20158 being aborted early, inducing frequent TLS renegotiations. These may also be
20159 caused by too large requests that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining
20160 HTTP 400 errors. Ideally this number should remain zero, though it may be
20161 possible that some browsers playing with the protocol boundaries trigger it
20162 once in a while. These values should normally not be considered as alarming
20163 (especially small ones), though a sudden jump may indicate an anomaly
20164 somewhere. Large values (i.e. hundreds to thousands per connection, or as
20165 many as the requests) may indicate a purposely built client that is trying to
20166 fingerprint or attack the protocol stack. Not all protocol multiplexers
20167 measure this metric, and the only way to get more details about the events is
20168 to enable traces to capture all exchanges.
20169
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020170fc_http_major : integer
20171 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20172 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20173 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20174
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020175fc_lost : integer
20176 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20177 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20178 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20179 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20180
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020181fc_pp_authority : string
20182 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20183 if any.
20184
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020185fc_pp_unique_id : string
20186 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20187 if any.
20188
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020189fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20190 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20191 header.
20192
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020193fc_reordering : integer
20194 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20195 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20196 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20197 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20198
20199fc_retrans : integer
20200 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20201 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20202 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20203 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20204
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020205fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20206 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20207 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20208 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20209 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20210 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20211 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20212
20213fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20214 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20215 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20216 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20217 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20218 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20219 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20220
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020221fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020222 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20223 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20224 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20225 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20226
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020227fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020228 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20229 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20230 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020231
20232fc_src_is_local : boolean
20233 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20234 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20235 "src_is_local" for details.
20236
20237fc_src_port : integer
20238
20239 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20240 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20241 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20242
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020243
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020244fc_unacked : integer
20245 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20246 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20247 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20248 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020249
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020250fe_defbe : string
20251 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20252 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020254fe_id : integer
20255 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020256 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020257 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20258
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020259fe_name : string
20260 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20261 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20262 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20263
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020264fe_client_timeout : integer
20265 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20266 current frontend.
20267
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020268sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020269sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20270sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20271sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020272 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20273 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20274 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20275
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020276sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020277sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20278sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20279sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020280 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20281 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20282 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20283
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020284sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20285 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20286 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20287 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20288 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20289 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20290 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20291 will always return zero.
20292 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20293 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020295sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020296sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20297sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20298sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020299 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20300 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020301 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20302 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20303 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020304
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020305 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020306 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20307 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020308 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20309 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20310 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020311 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20312 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20313
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020314sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20315sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20316sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20317sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20318 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20319 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20320 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20321 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20322 when a first ACL was verified.
20323
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020324sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020325sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20326sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20327sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020328 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020329 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20330
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020331sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020332sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20333sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20334sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020335 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20336 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20337 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20338
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020339sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020340sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20341sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20342sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020343 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20344 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20345 See also src_conn_rate.
20346
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020347sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20348 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20349 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20350 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20351 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20352 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20353 index, zero is returned.
20354 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20355 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20356
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020357sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020358sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20359sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20360sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020361 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020362 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020363
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020364sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20365sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20366sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20367sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20368 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20369 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20370
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020371sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20372 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20373 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20374 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20375 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20376 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20377 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20378 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20379
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020380sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20381sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20382sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20383sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20384 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20385 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20386
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020387sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20388 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20389 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20390 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20391 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20392 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20393 between 0 and 2.
20394 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20395 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20396 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20397 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20398 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020400sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020401sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20402sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20403sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020404 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20405 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20406 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020407 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20408 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20409 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020410
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020411sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20412sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20413sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20414sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20415 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20416 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20417 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20418 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20419 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20420 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020422sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020423sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20424sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20425sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020426 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020427 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20428 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020430sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020431sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20432sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20433sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020434 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20435 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20436 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20437 src_http_err_rate.
20438
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020439sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20440sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20441sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20442sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20443 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20444 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20445 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20446
20447sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20448sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20449sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20450sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20451 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20452 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20453 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20454 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020456sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020457sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20458sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20459sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020460 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020461 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20462 src_http_req_cnt.
20463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020464sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020465sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20466sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20467sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020468 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20469 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20470 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20471 src_http_req_rate.
20472
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020473sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20474 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20475 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20476 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20477 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20478 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20479 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20480 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20481 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20482 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020484sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020485sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20486sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20487sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020488 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020489 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20490 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20491 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20492 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020493
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020494 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020495 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20496 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20498
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020499sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20500sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20501sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20502sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20503 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20504 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20505 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20506 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20507 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020509sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020510sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20511sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20512sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020513 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20514 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20515 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020516
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020517sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020518sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20519sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20520sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020521 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20522 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20523 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020524
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020525sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020526sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20527sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20528sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020529 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020530 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20531 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20532 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020533 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020534 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020536sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020537sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20538sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20539sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020540 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20541 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20542 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20543 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20544 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020545 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020546
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020547sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020548sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20549sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20550sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020551 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20552 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20553 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020555sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020556sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20557sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20558sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020559 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20560 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020561 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020562 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20563 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020564 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20565 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20566 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020568so_id : integer
20569 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20570 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20571 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020572
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020573so_name : string
20574 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20575 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20576 strings instead of integers.
20577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020578src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020579 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20580 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20581 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20582 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20583 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20584 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20585 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20586 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20587 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20588 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20589 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20590 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20591 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20592 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20593 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020594
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020595 Example:
20596 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20597 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020599src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20600 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20601 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20602 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020603 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020605src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20606 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20607 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020608 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020609 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020610
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020611src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20612 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20613 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20614 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20615 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20616 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20617 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20618 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20619 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020621src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20622 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20623 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20624 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20625 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20626 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20627 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020628
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020629 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020630 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20631 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20632 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20633 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020634 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020635 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20636 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20637
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020638src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20639 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20640 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20641 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20642 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20643 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20644 was verified.
20645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020646src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020647 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020648 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020649 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020650 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020652src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020653 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020654 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20655 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020656 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020658src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20659 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20660 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20661 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020662 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020663
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020664src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20665 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20666 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20667 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20668 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20669 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20670 is returned.
20671 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20672 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20673 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020675src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020676 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020677 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020678 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020679 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020680
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020681src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20682 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20683 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20684 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20685 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20686
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020687src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20688 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20689 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20690 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20691 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20692 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20693 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20694
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020695src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20696 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20697 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20698 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20699 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20700
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020701src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20702 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20703 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20704 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20705 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20706 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20707 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20708 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20709 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20710 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20711 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020713src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020714 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020715 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020716 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20717 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020718 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20719 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20720 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020721
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020722src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20723 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20724 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20725 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20726 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20727 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20728 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20729 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020731src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020732 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020733 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020734 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020735 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020736 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020738src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20739 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20740 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20741 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20742 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020743 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020744
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020745src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20746 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20747 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020748 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020749 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20750 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20751
20752src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20753 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20754 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20755 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20756 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20757 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20758 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020760src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020761 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020762 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20763 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020764 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020766src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20767 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20768 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20769 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020770 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020771 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020772
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020773src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20774 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20775 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20776 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20777 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20778 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20779 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20780 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20781 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020783src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20784 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20785 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20786 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020787 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020788 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20789 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020790
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020791 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020792 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020793 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020794 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020795
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020796src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20797 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20798 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20799 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20800 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20801 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20802 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20803
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020804src_is_local : boolean
20805 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20806 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20807 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20808 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020809 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020810 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20811 once per connection.
20812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020813src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020814 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20815 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20816 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20817 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20818 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020820src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020821 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20822 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20823 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20824 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20825 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020827src_port : integer
20828 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020829 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20830 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20831 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20832 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020834src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020835 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020836 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20837 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20838 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020839 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020841src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20842 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20843 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20844 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20845 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020846 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020848src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20849 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20850 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20851 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20852 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20853 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20854 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20855 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20856 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020857
20858 Example :
20859 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20860 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20861 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20862 listen ssh
20863 bind :22
20864 mode tcp
20865 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020866 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020867 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020868 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020870srv_id : integer
20871 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20872 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020873 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020874
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020875srv_name : string
20876 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20877 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020878 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020879
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020881----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020882
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020883The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020884closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20885when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20886usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020887future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002088951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20890 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20891 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20892 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20893 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20894 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20895
20896 Example :
20897 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20898 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20899 # the request.
20900 frontend http-in
20901 bind *:8081
20902 default_backend servers
20903 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20904 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20905
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020906ssl_bc : boolean
20907 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20908 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020909 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020910 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020911
20912ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20913 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020914 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20915 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020916
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020917ssl_bc_alpn : string
20918 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20919 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020920 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020921 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20922 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20923 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20924 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20925 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020926 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20927 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020928
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020929ssl_bc_cipher : string
20930 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020931 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20932 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020933
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020934ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20935 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20936 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20937 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020938 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020940ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020941 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020942 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20943 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20944 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20945 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020946 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20947 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20948 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20949
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020950ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020951 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020952 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20953 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20954 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020955
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020956ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20957 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20958 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020959 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20960 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020961
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020962ssl_bc_npn : string
20963 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20964 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020965 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020966 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20967 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20968 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20969 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020970 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20971 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020972
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020973ssl_bc_protocol : string
20974 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020975 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20976 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020977
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020978ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020979 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020980 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020981 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20982 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020983
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020984ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20985 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20986 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20987 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020988 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020989
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020990ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20991 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20992 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020993 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20994 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020995
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020996ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20997 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20998 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20999 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021000 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021001
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021002ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
21003 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021004 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
21005 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021007ssl_c_ca_err : integer
21008 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21009 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
21010 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
21011 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
21012 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020021013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021014ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
21015 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21016 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
21017 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
21018 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021019
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021020ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021021 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
21022 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21023 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021024 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021025 does not support resumed sessions.
21026
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021027ssl_c_der : binary
21028 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
21029 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21030 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021032ssl_c_err : integer
21033 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21034 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
21035 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
21036 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21037 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021038
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021039ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021040 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21041 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21042 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21043 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21044 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21045 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21046 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21047 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021048 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21049 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21050 LDAP v3.
21051 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21052 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021054ssl_c_key_alg : string
21055 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21056 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21057 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021059ssl_c_notafter : string
21060 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
21061 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21062 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020021063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021064ssl_c_notbefore : string
21065 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
21066 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21067 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021068
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070021069ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21070 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
21071 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
21072 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
21073 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
21074 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
21075 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
21076 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
21077 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
21078 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
21079 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
21080 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
21081 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21082
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021083ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021084 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21085 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21086 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21087 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21088 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21089 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21090 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21091 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021092 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21093 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21094 LDAP v3.
21095 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21096 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021098ssl_c_serial : binary
21099 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
21100 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21101 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021103ssl_c_sha1 : binary
21104 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
21105 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
21106 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021107 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
21108 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
21109
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021110 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021111 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021113ssl_c_sig_alg : string
21114 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21115 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21116 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021118ssl_c_used : boolean
21119 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
21120 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021122ssl_c_verify : integer
21123 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
21124 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
21125 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
21126 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021128ssl_c_version : integer
21129 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
21130 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021131
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010021132ssl_f_der : binary
21133 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
21134 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21135 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21136
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021137ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021138 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21139 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21140 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21141 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021142 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021143 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21144 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21145 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021146 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21147 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21148 LDAP v3.
21149 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21150 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021152ssl_f_key_alg : string
21153 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21154 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21155 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021157ssl_f_notafter : string
21158 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21159 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21160 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021162ssl_f_notbefore : string
21163 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21164 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21165 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021166
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021167ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21169 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21170 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21171 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21172 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21173 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21174 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21175 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021176 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21177 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21178 LDAP v3.
21179 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21180 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021182ssl_f_serial : binary
21183 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21184 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21185 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021186
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021187ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21188 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21189 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21190 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021192ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21193 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21194 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21195 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021197ssl_f_version : integer
21198 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21199 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21200
21201ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021202 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21203 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21204 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021206 Example :
21207 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21208 listen http-https
21209 bind :80
21210 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21211 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21212
21213ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21214 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21215 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21216
21217ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021218 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021219 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021220 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021221 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21222 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21223 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21224 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21225 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21226 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021228ssl_fc_cipher : string
21229 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21230 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021231
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021232ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21233 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21234 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021235 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021236 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21237 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21238 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021239
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021240 Example:
21241 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21242 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21243 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21244 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21245 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21246 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21247 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21248 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21249 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21250
21251ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021252 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021253 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021254 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21255 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021256 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21257 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021258
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021259ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021260 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021261 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021262 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021263 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21264 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21265 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21266 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21267 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21268 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021269
21270ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021271 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021272 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21273 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021274
21275ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21276 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21277 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021278 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021279
21280 Example:
21281 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21282 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21283 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21284 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21285 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21286 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21287 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21288 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21289 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21290
21291ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21292 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21293 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021294 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021295 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21296 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21297 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21298
21299 Example:
21300 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21301 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21302 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21303 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21304 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21305 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21306 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21307 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21308 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21309
21310ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21311 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21312 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021313 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021314 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21315 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21316 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21317
21318 Example:
21319 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21320 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21321 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21322 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21323 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21324 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21325 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21326 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21327 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021328
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021329ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21330 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21331 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21332 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21333
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021334ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21335 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21336 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21337 transport layer.
21338 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21339 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21340 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21341 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21342
21343ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21344 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21345 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21346 transport layer.
21347 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21348 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21349 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21350 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21351
21352ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21353 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21354 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21355 transport layer.
21356 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21357 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21358 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21359 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21360
21361ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21362 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21363 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21364 transport layer.
21365 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21366 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21367 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21368 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21369
21370ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21371 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21372 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21373 transport layer.
21374 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21375 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21376 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21377 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21378
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021379ssl_fc_err : integer
21380 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21381 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21382 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21383 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21384 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21385 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21386 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21387 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21388 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21389 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21390 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21391 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21392 codes.
21393
21394ssl_fc_err_str : string
21395 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21396 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21397 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21398 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21399 also "ssl_fc_err".
21400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021401ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021402 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21403 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021404 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21405 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21406 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21407 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021408
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021409ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21410 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21411 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21412 wait until the handshake happened.
21413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021414ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21415 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021416 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21417 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021418 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021419 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021420
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021421ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021422 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021423 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21424 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021426ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021427 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021428 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021429 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21430 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21431 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21432 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21433 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21434 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021436ssl_fc_protocol : string
21437 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21438 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021439
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021440ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21441 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21442 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021443 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21444 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021445
21446 Example:
21447 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21448 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21449 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21450 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21451 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21452 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21453 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21454 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21455 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21456
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021457ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021458 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021459 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021460 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021461
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021462ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21463 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21464 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21465 transport layer.
21466 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21467 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21468 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21469 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21470
21471ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21472 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21473 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21474 transport layer.
21475 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21476 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21477 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21478 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21479
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021480ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21481 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21482 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21483 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021485ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21486 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21487 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21488 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21489 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021490
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021491ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21492 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21493 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21494 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21495 BoringSSL.
21496
21497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021498ssl_fc_sni : string
21499 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21500 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021501 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021502 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21503 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21504
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021505 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021506 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021507 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021508 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021509 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021510
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021511 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21512 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21513 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21514 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21515 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21516 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21517 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21518 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21519 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021521 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021522 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21523 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021525ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21526 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21527 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021528
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021529ssl_s_der : binary
21530 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21531 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21532 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21533
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021534ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21535 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21536 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21537 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021538 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021539 does not support resumed sessions.
21540
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021541ssl_s_key_alg : string
21542 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21543 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21544 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21545
21546ssl_s_notafter : string
21547 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21548 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21549 transport layer.
21550
21551ssl_s_notbefore : string
21552 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21553 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21554 transport layer.
21555
21556ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21557 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21558 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21559 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21560 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21561 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21562 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021563 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21564 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021565 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21566 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21567 LDAP v3.
21568 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21569 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21570
21571ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21572 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21573 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21574 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21575 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21576 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21577 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021578 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21579 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021580 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21581 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21582 LDAP v3.
21583 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21584 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21585
21586ssl_s_serial : binary
21587 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21588 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21589 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21590
21591ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21592 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21593 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21594 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21595
21596ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21597 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21598 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21599 layer.
21600
21601ssl_s_version : integer
21602 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21603 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021604
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200216057.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021606------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021608Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21609sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21610only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21611For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21612be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21613can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21614sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21615for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21616content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021617
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021618Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21619 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021620 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021621 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21622 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21623 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21624 sample expression). So be careful.
21625
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021626distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21627 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21628 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21629 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21630 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21631 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21632 list of supported tokens.
21633
21634distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21635 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21636 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21637 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21638 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21639 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21640 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21641 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21642 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21643 supported tokens.
21644
21645 Example :
21646 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21647 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21648 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21649 # send large files to the big farm
21650 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021652payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021653 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021654 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21655 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021657payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21658 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021659 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021660 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021662req.len : integer
21663req_len : integer (deprecated)
21664 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21665 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21666 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21667 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21668 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021669 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021670 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21671 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021673req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21674 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021675 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21676 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21677 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21678 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021679
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021680 ACL derivatives :
21681 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021683req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21684 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21685 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21686 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21687 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021688
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021689 ACL derivatives :
21690 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021692 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021694req.proto_http : boolean
21695req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21696 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21697 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21698 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21699 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21700 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21701 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21702 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021704 Example:
21705 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21706 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21707 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021708 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021710req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21711rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21712 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21713 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21714 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21715 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21716 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21717 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21718 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021720 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21721 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21722 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21723 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21724 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21725 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021727 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021728 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021730 Example :
21731 listen tse-farm
21732 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21733 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21734 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21735 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21736 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21737 persist rdp-cookie
21738 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21739 # This is only useful makes sense if
21740 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21741 stick-table type string size 204800
21742 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21743 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21744 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021746 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021747 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021749req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21750rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21751 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21752 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21753 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21754 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021756 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021757 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021758
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021759req.ssl_alpn : string
21760 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21761 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21762 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21763 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21764 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21765 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021766 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021767
21768 Examples :
21769 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21770 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021771 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021772 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021773 default_backend bk_default
21774
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021775req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21776 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21777 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021778 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21779 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21780 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21781 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21782 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021784req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21785req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21786 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21787 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21788 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21789 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21790 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21791 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21792 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021794req.ssl_sni : string
21795req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21796 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21797 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21798 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21799 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21800 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021801 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21802 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21803 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21804 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21805 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21806 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21807 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21808 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21809 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021811 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021812 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021814 Examples :
21815 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21816 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021817 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021818 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021819 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021820
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021821req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21822 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21823 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21824 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21825 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21826 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21827 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21828 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21829 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21830 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021832req.ssl_ver : integer
21833req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21834 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21835 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21836 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21837 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21838 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21839 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21840 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021841 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021842 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021844 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021845 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021846
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021847res.len : integer
21848 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21849 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21850 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21851 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21852 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021853 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021854 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021855 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021857res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21858 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021859 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021860 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021861 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021862 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021864res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21865 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21866 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21867 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021868 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21869 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021871 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021872
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021873res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21874rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21875 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21876 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21877 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21878 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21879 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21880 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21881 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021883wait_end : boolean
21884 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21885 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021886 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021887 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21888 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021889 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021890 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21891 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021893 Examples :
21894 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21895 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21896 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021898 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21899 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21900 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21901 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21902 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21903 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21904 tcp-request content reject
21905
21906
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200219077.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021908--------------------------------------
21909
21910It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21911This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21912data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21913its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21914HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21915content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21916to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21917more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21918response are indexed.
21919
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021920Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21921 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21922 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21923 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21924 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21925 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21926 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021928base : string
21929 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21930 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21931 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21932 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21933 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21934 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21935 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21936 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21937
21938 ACL derivatives :
21939 base : exact string match
21940 base_beg : prefix match
21941 base_dir : subdir match
21942 base_dom : domain match
21943 base_end : suffix match
21944 base_len : length match
21945 base_reg : regex match
21946 base_sub : substring match
21947
21948base32 : integer
21949 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21950 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21951 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021952 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21953 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21954 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021955
21956base32+src : binary
21957 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21958 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21959 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21960 per-URL counters.
21961
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021962baseq : string
21963 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21964 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21965 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21966 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21967
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021968capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21969 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21970 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21971 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21972
21973capture.req.method : string
21974 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21975 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21976 because it's allocated.
21977
21978capture.req.uri : string
21979 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21980 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21981 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21982 allocated.
21983
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021984capture.req.ver : string
21985 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21986 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21987 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21988
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021989capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21990 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21991 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21992 The first entry is an index of 0.
21993 See also: "capture response header"
21994
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021995capture.res.ver : string
21996 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21997 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21998 persistent flag.
21999
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022000req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022001 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
22002 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
22003 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022004
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022005req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022006 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
22007 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
22008 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
22009 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022010 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
22011 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
22012 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
22013 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
22014 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
22015 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022016
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022017req.body_len : integer
22018 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
22019 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022020 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
22021 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022022
22023req.body_size : integer
22024 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022025 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22026 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022028req.cook([<name>]) : string
22029cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22030 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22031 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
22032 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
22033 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
22034 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
22035 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
22036 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
22037 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
22038
22039 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022040 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
22041 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
22042 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
22043 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
22044 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
22045 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
22046 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
22047 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022049req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22050cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22051 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22052 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022054req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22055cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22056 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22057 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
22058 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
22059 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022061cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22062 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22063 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
22064 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
22065 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022066 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022067 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
22068 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
22069 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
22070 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022072hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22073 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
22074 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
22075 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
22076 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022077 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022079req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022080 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
22081 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
22082 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
22083 with headers such as User-Agent.
22084
22085 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22086 found.
22087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022088 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22089 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22090 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022091 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022093req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22094 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22095 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022096 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
22097 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022099req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022100 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
22101 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
22102 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
22103 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
22104 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
22105 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
22106 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
22107
22108 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22109 found.
22110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022111 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22112 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22113 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022114 with -1 being the last one.
22115
22116 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
22117 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022119 ACL derivatives :
22120 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22121 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22122 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22123 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22124 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22125 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22126 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22127 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
22128
22129req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22130hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
22131 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22132 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022133 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
22134 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
22135 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
22136
22137 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
22138 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
22139 which contain more than one of certain headers.
22140
22141 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022142
22143req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22144hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
22145 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
22146 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22147 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022148 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22149 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22150 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22151 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22152 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022153
22154 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22155
22156 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022157
22158req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22159hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22160 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22161 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22162 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022163
22164 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22165
22166 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022167
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022168req.hdrs : string
22169 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22170 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22171 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22172 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22173
22174req.hdrs_bin : binary
22175 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22176 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22177 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22178 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22179 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22180 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22181
22182 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022183
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022184 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22185 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022187http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22188 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22189 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22190 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22191 basic auth is supported.
22192
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022193http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22194 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22195 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22196 performed on the data sent by the client.
22197 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22198 Authorization one.
22199
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022200http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22201 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22202 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22203 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22204 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022205 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22206 basic auth is supported.
22207
22208 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022209 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22210 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22211 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22212 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022213
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022214http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022215 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22216 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22217 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022218
22219http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022220 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22221 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22222 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022223
22224http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022225 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22226 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22227 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022229http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022230 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22231 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022232 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22233 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022235method : integer + string
22236 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22237 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22238 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22239 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22240 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22241 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22242 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022244 ACL derivatives :
22245 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022247 Example :
22248 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22249 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22250 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022252path : string
22253 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22254 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22255 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22256 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22257 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022258 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022259 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22260 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22261 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22262 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22263 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022265 ACL derivatives :
22266 path : exact string match
22267 path_beg : prefix match
22268 path_dir : subdir match
22269 path_dom : domain match
22270 path_end : suffix match
22271 path_len : length match
22272 path_reg : regex match
22273 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022274
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022275pathq : string
22276 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22277 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22278 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22279 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22280 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022281 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22282 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22283 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22284 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22285 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022286
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022287query : string
22288 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22289 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22290 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22291 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022292 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022293 which stops before the question mark.
22294
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022295req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22296 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22297 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22298 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22299 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022301req.ver : string
22302req_ver : string (deprecated)
22303 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022304 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22305 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22306
22307 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22308
22309 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22310 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22311 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022313 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022314 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022315
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022316res.body : binary
22317 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22318 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022319 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22320
22321 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022322
22323res.body_len : integer
22324 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22325 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022326 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22327
22328 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022329
22330res.body_size : integer
22331 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22332 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22333 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22334 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022335 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22336
22337 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022338
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022339res.cache_hit : boolean
22340 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22341 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22342
22343res.cache_name : string
22344 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22345 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22346 empty string.
22347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022348res.comp : boolean
22349 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22350 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22351 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022353res.comp_algo : string
22354 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22355 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22356 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022358res.cook([<name>]) : string
22359scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22360 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22361 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022362 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22363
22364 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022366 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022367 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022369res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22370scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22372 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022373 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22374
22375 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022377res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22378scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22379 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22380 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022381 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22382
22383 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022385res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022386 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22387 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22388
22389 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22390 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22391
22392 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22393
22394 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022396res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022397 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22398 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22399
22400 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22401 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22402
22403 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022405res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22406shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022407 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22408 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22409
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022410 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022411 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22412
22413 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022415 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022416 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22417 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22418 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22419 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22420 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22421 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22422 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22423 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022424
22425res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22426shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022427 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22428 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22429
22430 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022431 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022432
22433 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022435res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22436shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022437 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22438 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22439
22440 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22441
22442 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022443
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022444res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22445 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22446 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22447 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022448 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22449
22450 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022452res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22453shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022454 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22455 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22456
22457 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22458
22459 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022460
22461res.hdrs : string
22462 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22463 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22464 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022465 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22466
22467 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022468
22469res.hdrs_bin : binary
22470 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22471 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22472 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22473 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22474 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22475 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22476 (length of 0 for both).
22477
22478 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22479
22480 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22481 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022483res.ver : string
22484resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22485 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022486 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22487
22488 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022490 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022491 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022493set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22494 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22495 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022496 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022497 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022499 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22500 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022502status : integer
22503 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22504 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022505 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22506
22507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022508
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022509unique-id : string
22510 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22511 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22512 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22513 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22514 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22515 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022517url : string
22518 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22519 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22520 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22521 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22522 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22523 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022524 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22525 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22526 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22527 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22528 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022530 ACL derivatives :
22531 url : exact string match
22532 url_beg : prefix match
22533 url_dir : subdir match
22534 url_dom : domain match
22535 url_end : suffix match
22536 url_len : length match
22537 url_reg : regex match
22538 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022540url_ip : ip
22541 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22542 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22543 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22544 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022545 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22546 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022548url_port : integer
22549 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022550 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022551
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022552urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22553url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022554 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22555 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022556 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22557 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22558 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22559 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22560 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22561 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22562 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22563 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022565 ACL derivatives :
22566 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22567 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22568 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22569 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22570 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22571 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22572 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22573 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022574
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022576 Example :
22577 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22578 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22579 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22580 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022581
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022582urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022583 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22584 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22585 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022586
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022587url32 : integer
22588 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22589 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22590 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22591 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22592 is an unsigned integer.
22593
22594url32+src : binary
22595 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22596 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22597 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22598
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022599
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200226007.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022601---------------------------------------
22602
22603This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22604used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22605purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22606There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22607or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22608any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22609for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22610
22611internal.htx.data : integer
22612 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22613 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22614
22615internal.htx.free : integer
22616 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22617 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22618
22619internal.htx.free_data : integer
22620 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22621 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22622
22623internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022624 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22625 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22626 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022627
22628internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22629 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22630 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22631
22632internal.htx.size : integer
22633 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22634 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22635
22636internal.htx.used : integer
22637 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22638 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22639 direction.
22640
22641internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22642 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22643 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22644 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22645 of the special value :
22646 * head : The oldest inserted block
22647 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022648 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022649
22650internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22651 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22652 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22653 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22654 integer or one of the special value :
22655 * head : The oldest inserted block
22656 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022657 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022658
22659internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22660 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22661 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22662 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22663 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22664
22665 * head : The oldest inserted block
22666 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022667 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022668
22669internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22670 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22671 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22672 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22673 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22674
22675 * head : The oldest inserted block
22676 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022677 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022678
22679internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22680 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22681 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22682 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22683 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22684
22685 * head : The oldest inserted block
22686 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022687 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022688
22689internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22690 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22691 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22692 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22693 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22694
22695 * head : The oldest inserted block
22696 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022697 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022698
22699internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22700 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22701 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22702 it returns false.
22703
22704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200227057.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022706---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022708Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22709every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022710order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022712ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022713---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22714FALSE always_false never match
22715HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22716HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22717HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022718HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022719HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22720HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22721HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22722HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022723LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022724METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22725METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22726METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22727METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22728METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22729METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22730METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22731METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22732RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22733REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22734TRUE always_true always match
22735WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22736---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022737
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227398. Logging
22740----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022741
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022742One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22743provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22744very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22745provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22746state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022747to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022748headers.
22749
22750In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22751about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22752send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22753
22754 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22755 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22756 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22757 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22758 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022759 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022760 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022761
22762The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22763allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22764as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22765while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22766real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22767delay.
22768
22769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227708.1. Log levels
22771---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022772
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022773TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022774source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022775HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22776in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22777track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22778syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22779about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022780
22781
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227828.2. Log formats
22783----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022784
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022785HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022786and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22787slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22788options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022789
22790 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22791 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22792 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22793 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22794 extents.
22795
22796 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22797 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22798 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22799 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22800 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22801
22802 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22803 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22804 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22805 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22806 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22807
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022808 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22809 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22810 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22811 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22812
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022813 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22814
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022815Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22816specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22817field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22818servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22819always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22820identifier.
22821
22822Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22823 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22824 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22825 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22826 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22827
22828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228298.2.1. Default log format
22830-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022831
22832This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22833as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22834format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22835
22836 Example :
22837 listen www
22838 mode http
22839 log global
22840 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22841
22842 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22843 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22844 (www/HTTP)
22845
22846 Field Format Extract from the example above
22847 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22848 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22849 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22850 4 'to' to
22851 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22852 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22853
22854Detailed fields description :
22855 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22856 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22857 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22858 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22859 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22860 and processed the connection.
22861 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22862
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022863In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22864"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22865connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022867It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22868will eventually disappear.
22869
22870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228718.2.2. TCP log format
22872---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022873
22874The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22875is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22876information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22877counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22878emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22879environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22880the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22881sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022882specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022883not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22884
22885The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22886exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022887if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22888Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022889
22890 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22891 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22892 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022893 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22894 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022895
22896A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22897are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022898
22899 Example :
22900 frontend fnt
22901 mode tcp
22902 option tcplog
22903 log global
22904 default_backend bck
22905
22906 backend bck
22907 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22908
22909 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22910 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22911 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22912
22913 Field Format Extract from the example above
22914 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22915 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22916 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22917 4 frontend_name fnt
22918 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22919 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22920 7 bytes_read* 212
22921 8 termination_state --
22922 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22923 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22924
22925Detailed fields description :
22926 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022927 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022928 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22929 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022930 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022931 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022932 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022933
22934 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022935 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22936 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22937 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022938
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022939 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022940 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22941 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022942 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22943 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22944 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22945 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022946
22947 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22948 and processed the connection.
22949
22950 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22951 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22952 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22953 applications.
22954
22955 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22956 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22957 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22958 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22959 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22960
22961 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22962 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22963 See "Timers" below for more details.
22964
22965 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22966 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22967 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22968 "Timers" below for more details.
22969
22970 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022971 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022972 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22973 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22974 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22975 details.
22976
22977 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22978 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22979 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22980 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22981 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22982
22983 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22984 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22985 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22986 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22987 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22988 for more details.
22989
22990 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022991 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022992 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22993 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22994 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022995 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022996
22997 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22998 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22999 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23000 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23001 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23002 caused by a denial of service attack.
23003
23004 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23005 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23006 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23007 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23008 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23009 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23010 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23011 denial of service attack.
23012
23013 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23014 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23015 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23016 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23017 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23018 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23019 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23020 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
23021 be processed than on other servers.
23022
23023 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23024 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23025 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23026 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023027 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023028 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23029 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23030 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23031 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23032 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23033 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23034 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23035 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23036
23037 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23038 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23039 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23040 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23041 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23042 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023043 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023044 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23045
23046 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23047 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23048 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23049 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23050 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23051 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023052 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023053 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23054 occurs.
23055
23056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230578.2.3. HTTP log format
23058----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023059
23060The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
23061is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
23062the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
23063are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
23064emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
23065generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
23066"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
23067which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023068frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
23069is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023070
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023071The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23072exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023073if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23074instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023075
23076 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
23077 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23078 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
23079
23080And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
23081this exact string:
23082
23083 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
23084 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
23085 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
23086 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023087 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
23088 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023090Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
23091slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
23092with a star ('*') after the field name below.
23093
23094 Example :
23095 frontend http-in
23096 mode http
23097 option httplog
23098 log global
23099 default_backend bck
23100
23101 backend static
23102 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
23103
23104 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23105 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
23106 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023107 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023108
23109 Field Format Extract from the example above
23110 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23111 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023112 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023113 4 frontend_name http-in
23114 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023115 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023116 7 status_code 200
23117 8 bytes_read* 2750
23118 9 captured_request_cookie -
23119 10 captured_response_cookie -
23120 11 termination_state ----
23121 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23122 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23123 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23124 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23125 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023127Detailed fields description :
23128 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023129 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023130 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
23131 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023132 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023133 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023134 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023135
23136 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023137 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
23138 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
23139 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023140
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023141 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023142 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023143
23144 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23145 and processed the connection.
23146
23147 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23148 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23149 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23150
23151 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23152 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23153 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23154 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23155 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23156 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23157
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023158 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23159 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23160 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023161 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023162 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23163 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023164 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023165 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023166
23167 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23168 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023169 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023170
23171 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23172 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023173 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23174 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023175
23176 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23177 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23178 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23179 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23180 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023181 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23182 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023184 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023185 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23186 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23187 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23188 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23189 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23190 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023191 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023192
23193 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023194 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23195 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023196
23197 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23198 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023199 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023200 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23201 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23202 overflowing.
23203
23204 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23205 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23206 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23207 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23208 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23209 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23210 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23211 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23212
23213 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23214 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23215 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23216 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23217 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23218 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23219 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23220 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23221
23222 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23223 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23224 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23225 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23226 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23227 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23228 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23229
23230 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023231 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23233 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23234 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023235 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023236 system.
23237
23238 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23239 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23240 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23241 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23242 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23243 caused by a denial of service attack.
23244
23245 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23246 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23247 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23248 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23249 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23250 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23251 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23252 denial of service attack.
23253
23254 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23255 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23256 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23257 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23258 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23259 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23260 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23261 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23262 processed than on other servers.
23263
23264 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23265 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23266 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23267 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023268 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023269 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23270 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23271 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23272 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23273 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23274 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23275 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23276 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23277
23278 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23279 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23280 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23281 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23282 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23283 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023284 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023285 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23286
23287 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23288 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23289 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23290 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23291 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23292 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023293 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023294 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23295 occurs.
23296
23297 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23298 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23299 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23300 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23301 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23302 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23303 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23304 cookies" below for more details.
23305
23306 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23307 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23308 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23309 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23310 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23311 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23312 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23313 and cookies" below for more details.
23314
23315 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23316 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23317 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23318 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23319 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23320 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23321 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23322 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23323
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023324
233258.2.4. HTTPS log format
23326----------------------
23327
23328The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23329extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23330information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23331frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23332end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23333matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23334sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23335dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23336"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23337
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023338The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23339exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023340if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23341instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023342
23343 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23344 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23345 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23346 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023347 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023348 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23349 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023350
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023351This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23352appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23353HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023354
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023355 Example :
23356 frontend https-in
23357 mode http
23358 option httpslog
23359 log global
23360 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23361 default_backend bck
23362
23363 backend static
23364 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23365
23366 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23367 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23368 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023369 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23370 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023371
23372 Field Format Extract from the example above
23373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23374 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23375 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23376 4 frontend_name https-in
23377 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23378 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23379 7 status_code 200
23380 8 bytes_read* 2750
23381 9 captured_request_cookie -
23382 10 captured_response_cookie -
23383 11 termination_state ----
23384 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23385 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23386 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23387 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23388 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023389 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023390 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023391 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23392 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023393
23394Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023395 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23396 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23397 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023398
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023399 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23400 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23401 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023402 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023403 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023404
23405 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23406 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23407 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23408 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23409
23410 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23411 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23412 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23413 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23414
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023415 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23416 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23417 can be shared by multiple requests.
23418
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023419 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23420 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23421 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23422 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23423 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23424
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023425 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23426
23427 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23428
23429
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100234308.2.5. Error log format
23431-----------------------
23432
23433When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23434protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23435unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23436line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23437"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23438will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23439logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23440
23441The default format looks like this :
23442
23443 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23444 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23445 Connection error during SSL handshake
23446
23447 Field Format Extract from the example above
23448 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23449 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23450 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23451 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23452 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23453
23454These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23455failures.
23456
23457By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23458above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23459defined format.
23460
23461An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23462source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23463number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23464internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23465error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23466the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23467certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23468indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23469indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23470ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23471are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23472would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23473regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23474
23475 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023476 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023477 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23478 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23479
23480
234818.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023482------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023483
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023484When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23485ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23486a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23487formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23488looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23489and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023491HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023492Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23493separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23494prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23495
23496Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23497variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023498("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023499
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023500If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023501as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023502less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23503the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23504
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023505Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23506"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23507delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23508preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023509
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023510Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23511'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23512https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23513such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23514
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023515Flags are :
23516 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023517 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023518 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23519 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023520
23521 Example:
23522
23523 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23524 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23525
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023526 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23527
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023528Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23529
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023530 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023531 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023532 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23533 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23534 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023535 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23536 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23537 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023538 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023539 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023540 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023541 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023542 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023543 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23544 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023545 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023546 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023547 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023548 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023549 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023550 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023551 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023552 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23553 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23554 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23555 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23556 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023557 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023558 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023559 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023560 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023561 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023562 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23563 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023564 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23565 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23566 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023567 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023568 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23569 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023570 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023571 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23572 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23573 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023574 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023575 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023576 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23577 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23578 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23579 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023580 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023581 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023582 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023583 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023584 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023585 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023586 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23587 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23588 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023589 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023590 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23591 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023592 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023593 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23594 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023595 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023596 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023597 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023598 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023599
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023600 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023601
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236038.3. Advanced logging options
23604-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023605
23606Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23607just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23608options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23609for more information about their usage.
23610
23611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236128.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23613------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023614
23615It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023616HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023617commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23618monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23619ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23620
23621 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23622 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23623 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23624 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23625
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023626 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23627 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023628
23629 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23630 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23631 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23632
23633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236348.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23635----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023636
23637The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23638what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23639or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023640"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023641just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23642log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23643after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23644is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23645with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23646with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23647
23648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236498.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23650------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023651
23652Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23653for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23654"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23655retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23656raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23657a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23658file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23659you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23660"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23661
23662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236638.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23664--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023665
23666Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23667multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23668them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23669"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23670logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23671error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23672and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23673too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23674useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23675alternative.
23676
23677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236788.4. Timing events
23679------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023680
23681Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23682reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23683the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23684frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023685mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23686addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23687
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023688Timings events in HTTP mode:
23689
23690 first request 2nd request
23691 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23692 t tr t tr ...
23693 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23694 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23695 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23696 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023697 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023698 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23699
23700Timings events in TCP mode:
23701
23702 TCP session
23703 |<----------------->|
23704 t t
23705 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23706 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23707 |<------ Tt ------->|
23708
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023709 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023710 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023711 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23712 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23713 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023714 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023715 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23716 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23717 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23718 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023720 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23721 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23722 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023723 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23724 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23725 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23726 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23727 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23728 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023729
23730 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23731 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23732 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23733 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23734 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23735 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23736 request typed by hand during a test.
23737
23738 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23739 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023740 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023741 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23742 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23743 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23744 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023745
23746 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23747 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23748 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23749 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23750 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23751
23752 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23753 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23754 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23755 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23756 connection never established.
23757
23758 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23759 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23760 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23761 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23762 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23763 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23764 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23765 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23766 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23767 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23768 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23769
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023770 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23771 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23772 (after Tr).
23773
23774 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23775 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23776
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023777 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23778 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23779 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23780 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23781 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23782 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23783
23784 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23785
23786 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23787 "Ta" can never be negative.
23788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023789 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23790 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023791 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23792 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023793 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023795 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023796
23797 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023798 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23799 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023800
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023801 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23802 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23803 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23804 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23805 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23806 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23807 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23808 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023810These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23811protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23812that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023813due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23814"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23815that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023816
23817Most common cases :
23818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023819 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23820 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23821 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23822 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23823 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023824 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023825 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23826 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23827 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23828 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23829 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023830 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023831
23832 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23833 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23834 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23835 of ms on remote networks.
23836
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023837 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23838 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23839 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023840
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023841 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23842 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023843 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023844 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23845 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23846 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23847 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23848 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23849 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023850
23851Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023853 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023854 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023855 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023857 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023858 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23859 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023861 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023862 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23863 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23864 flags.
23865
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023866 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23867 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023868 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23869 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23870 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23871 the client connection was maintained open.
23872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023873 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023874 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023875 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023876 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23877
23878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200238798.5. Session state at disconnection
23880-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023881
23882TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23883"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
238842-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23885each of which has a special meaning :
23886
23887 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23888 session to terminate :
23889
23890 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23891
23892 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23893 server explicitly refused it.
23894
23895 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23896 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23897 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23898 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023899 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023900
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023901 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023902
23903 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23904 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23905 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23906 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23907 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23908
23909 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23910 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23911 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23912 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23913 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023915 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023916 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23917
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023918 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023919 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23920 backup connections when going up.
23921
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023922 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023924 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23925 send or receive data.
23926
23927 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23928 send or receive data.
23929
23930 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23931 with nothing left in the buffers.
23932
23933 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23934
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023935 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023936 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23937
23938 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23939 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23940 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23941 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23942 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23943
23944 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23945 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23946
23947 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23948 server (HTTP only).
23949
23950 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23951
23952 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23953 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23954 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23955
23956 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23957 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23958 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23959
23960 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23961
23962 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23963 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23964
23965 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23966 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23967 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23968
23969 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23970 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023971 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23972 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023973
23974 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23975 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23976 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23977 another server.
23978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023979 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023980 server.
23981
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023982 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23983 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23984 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23985 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23986
23987 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23988 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23989 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23990 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23991
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023992 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23993 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23994 "use-server" rule).
23995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023996 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23997
23998 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23999 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
24000
24001 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
24002
24003 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
24004 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
24005 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
24006
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024007 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
24008 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030024009 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024010 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
24011 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
24012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024013 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
24014
24015 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
24016 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
24017
24018 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
24019
24020 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
24021
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024022The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
24023was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024024helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
24025starvation, attacks, etc...
24026
24027The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
24028alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
24029easier finding and understanding.
24030
24031 Flags Reason
24032
24033 -- Normal termination.
24034
24035 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024036 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
24037 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024038 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
24039
24040 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
24041 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024042 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
24043 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024044 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
24045 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024047 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24048 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024049 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024050
24051 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
24052 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
24053 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
24054
24055 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
24056 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
24057 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
24058 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
24059 the server takes too long to respond.
24060
24061 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
24062 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
24063 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
24064 long a time to respond.
24065
24066 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
24067 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
24068 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024069 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024070 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
24071 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024072
24073 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
24074 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
24075 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
24076 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
24077 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020024078 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024079 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
24080 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
24081 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
24082 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
24083 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
24084 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
24085 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
24086 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024087 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024088 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
24089 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
24090 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024091
24092 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
24093 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020024094 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
24095 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
24096 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
24097 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024098
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010024099 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24100 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
24101 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
24102
24103 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24104 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
24105 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
24106 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
24107
24108 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
24109 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
24110 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020024111
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024112 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024113 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
24114 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024115 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024116 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
24117 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
24118
24119 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
24120 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
24121 503 or 504 here.
24122
24123 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024124 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024125 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
24126 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
24127 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
24128
24129 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24130 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024131 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024132 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024133 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024134
24135 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
24136 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
24137 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
24138 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
24139 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
24140 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024141 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024142
24143 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
24144 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
24145 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
24146 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24147 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24148 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24149 solution is to fix the application.
24150
24151 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24152 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24153 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24154 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24155 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24156 external attacks.
24157
24158 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024159 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024160 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024161 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24162 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24163
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024164 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24165 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24166 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024167 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024168 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024169
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024170 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24171 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24172 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24173 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024174 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24175 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24176 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24177 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024178 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24179 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24180 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24181 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024182
24183 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24184 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24185 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024186 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24187 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24188 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24189 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024190
24191 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24192 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24193 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24194 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24195
24196 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24197 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24198 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24199 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24200
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024201The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024202persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024203important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24204re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24205
24206 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24207
24208 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24209 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24210 set on a GET request.
24211
24212 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24213 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024214 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024215 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24216
24217 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24218 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24219 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24220
24221 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24222 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24223 already got a cookie.
24224
24225 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24226 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24227 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24228 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24229 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24230
24231 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24232 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24233 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24234
24235 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24236 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24237 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24238
24239 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24240 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24241
24242 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24243 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24244 then advertised in the response.
24245
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242478.6. Non-printable characters
24248-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024249
24250In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24251consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24252converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24253prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24254being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24255escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24256is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24257'}' when logging headers.
24258
24259Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24260issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24261containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24262
24263Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24264the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24265performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24266
24267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242688.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24269---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024270
24271Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24272achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024273section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024274cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24275the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24276the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024277locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024278not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24279user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24280a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24281wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24282
24283 Examples :
24284 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24285 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24286
24287 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24288 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24289
24290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24292---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024293
24294Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24295proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24296the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24297server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24298
24299Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24300response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024301section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024302
24303It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024304time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24305appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024306are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24307and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24308follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24309request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24310in the logs.
24311
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024312As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24313frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24314an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024316 Example :
24317 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24318 listen proxy-out
24319 mode http
24320 option httplog
24321 option logasap
24322 log global
24323 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24324
24325 # log the name of the virtual server
24326 capture request header Host len 20
24327
24328 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24329 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24330
24331 # log the beginning of the referrer
24332 capture request header Referer len 20
24333
24334 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24335 capture response header Server len 20
24336
24337 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24338 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024340 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024341 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24342
24343 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24344 capture response header Via len 20
24345
24346 # log the URL location during a redirection
24347 capture response header Location len 20
24348
24349 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24350 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24351 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24352 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24353 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24354
24355 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24356 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24357 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24358 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024359 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024360
24361 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24362 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24363 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24364 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24365 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024366 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024367
24368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243698.9. Examples of logs
24370---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024371
24372These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24373them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24374reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24375
24376 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24377 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24378 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24379
24380 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24381 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24382
24383 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24384 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24385 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24386
24387 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24388 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24389
24390 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24391 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24392 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24393
24394 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024395 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024396 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24397 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24398
24399 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24400 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24401 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24402
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024403 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24404 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24405 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24406 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024407 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024408 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024409
24410 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024411 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024412
24413 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24414 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24415 Nothing was sent to any server.
24416
24417 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24418 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24419
24420 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24421 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024422 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024423 send a 408 return code to the client.
24424
24425 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24426 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24427
24428 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24429 5 seconds ("c----").
24430
24431 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24432 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024433 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024434
24435 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024436 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024437 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24438 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24439 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24440 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24441 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024442
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024443
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200244449. Supported filters
24445--------------------
24446
24447Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24448accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24449unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24450
24451See also : "filter"
24452
244539.1. Trace
24454----------
24455
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024456filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024457
24458 Arguments:
24459 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24460 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24461
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024462 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024464 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024465 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24466 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24467 amount of the parsed data.
24468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024469 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024470
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024471This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24472callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24473information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24474filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24475
24476Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24477tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24478a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24479
24480
244819.2. HTTP compression
24482---------------------
24483
24484filter compression
24485
24486The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24487keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024488when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24489fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24490done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24491explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24492filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24493listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24494order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024495
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024496See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24497 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024498
24499
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200245009.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24501--------------------------------------------
24502
24503filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24504
24505 Arguments :
24506
24507 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24508 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24509 parsed.
24510
24511 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24512 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24513 part must be placed in its own scope.
24514
24515The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24516external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024517streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024518exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24519also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24520
24521SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24522the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24523
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024524For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024525"doc/SPOE.txt".
24526
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100245279.4. Cache
24528----------
24529
24530filter cache <name>
24531
24532 Arguments :
24533
24534 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24535
24536The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24537"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024538cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024539other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24540case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24541is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24542filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024543listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24544order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024545
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024546See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24547 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24548
24549
245509.5. Fcgi-app
24551-------------
24552
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024553filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024554
24555 Arguments :
24556
24557 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24558
24559The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24560request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24561reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24562used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24563implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24564used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24565fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24566used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24567order.
24568
24569See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24570 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24571
24572
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100245739.6. OpenTracing
24574----------------
24575
24576The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24577HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24578of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24579Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24580
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024581This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024582
24583The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24584HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24585participates in the work of HAProxy.
24586
24587filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24588
24589 Arguments :
24590
24591 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24592 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24593 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24594 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24595 OpenTracing filters.
24596
24597 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24598 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24599 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24600 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24601 filter must have its own scope defined.
24602
24603More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024604of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024605
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200246069.7. Bandwidth limitation
24607--------------------------
24608
24609filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24610filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24611filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24612filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24613
24614 Arguments :
24615
24616 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24617 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24618
24619 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24620 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24621 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24622 expressed in bytes.
24623
24624 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24625 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24626 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24627 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24628
24629 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24630 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24631 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24632
24633 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024634 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024635 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24636 is expressed in milliseconds.
24637
24638 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24639 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24640 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24641 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24642 expressed in bytes.
24643
24644Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24645speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24646bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24647used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24648sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24649other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24650connections for a given client.
24651
24652The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24653filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24654definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24655the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24656compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24657the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24658for the cache filter.
24659
24660There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24661default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024662to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024663the table.
24664
24665In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24666limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24667forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24668the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24669used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24670cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24671level.
24672
24673The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24674connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24675of the same connection may have different limits.
24676
24677For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24678defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24679bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24680only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24681when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24682
24683For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24684incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24685corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24686stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24687used to limit outgoing data.
24688
24689Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24690limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24691to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24692carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24693it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24694limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24695experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24696a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24697start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24698some experimentations.
24699
24700 Example:
24701 frontend http
24702 bind *:80
24703 mode http
24704
24705 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24706 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24707 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24708
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024709 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024710 # independently of all other streams.
24711 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24712
24713 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24714 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24715 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24716 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24717 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24718 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24719 ...
24720
24721 backend limit-by-src
24722 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24723 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24724
24725See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24726 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24727 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24728 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024729
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002473010. FastCGI applications
24731-------------------------
24732
24733HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24734feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24735the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24736FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24737servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24738FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24739backend.
24740
24741HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24742application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24743connection.
24744
2474510.1. Setup
24746-----------
24747
2474810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24749--------------------------
24750
24751fcgi-app <name>
24752 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24753 document root must be defined.
24754
24755acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24756 Declare or complete an access list.
24757
24758 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24759 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24760 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24761 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24762 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24763
24764docroot <path>
24765 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24766 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24767 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24768
24769index <script-name>
24770 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24771 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24772 is an optional setting.
24773
24774 Example :
24775 index index.php
24776
24777log-stderr global
24778log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024779 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024780 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24781
24782 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24783 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24784
24785pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24786 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24787 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24788 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24789
24790 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24791 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24792 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24793 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24794
24795 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24796 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24797
24798path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024799 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024800 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24801 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24802 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24803 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24804 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24805 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24806 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024807
24808 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024809 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024810 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24811 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24812 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24813 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024814
24815 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024816 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24817 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024818
24819option get-values
24820no option get-values
24821 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24822
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024823 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024824 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24825
24826 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24827 application will accept.
24828
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024829 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24830 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024831
24832 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024833 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024834 option is disabled.
24835
24836 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24837 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24838 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24839 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24840 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24841 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24842
24843option keep-conn
24844no option keep-conn
24845 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24846 sending a response.
24847
24848 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24849 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24850
24851option max-reqs <reqs>
24852 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24853 accept.
24854
24855 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24856 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24857 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24858 to 1.
24859
24860option mpxs-conns
24861no option mpxs-conns
24862 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24863
24864 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24865 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24866
24867set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24868 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020024869 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.6
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024870 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24871 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24872
24873 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24874 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24875 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24876
24877 Example :
24878 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24879 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24880
24881 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24882
24883
2488410.1.2. Proxy section
24885---------------------
24886
24887use-fcgi-app <name>
24888 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24889
24890 Arguments :
24891 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24892
24893 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24894 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24895 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24896 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24897 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24898
24899 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24900 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24901 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24902 application are evaluated.
24903
24904
2490510.1.3. Example
24906---------------
24907
24908 frontend front-http
24909 mode http
24910 bind *:80
24911 bind *:
24912
24913 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24914 default_backend back-static
24915
24916 backend back-static
24917 mode http
24918 server www A.B.C.D:80
24919
24920 backend back-dynamic
24921 mode http
24922 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24923 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24924
24925 fcgi-app php-fpm
24926 log-stderr global
24927 option keep-conn
24928
24929 docroot /var/www/my-app
24930 index index.php
24931 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24932
24933
2493410.2. Default parameters
24935------------------------
24936
24937A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24938the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024939script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024940applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24941
24942 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24943 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24944 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24945 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24946 | | |
24947 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24948 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24949 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24950 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24951 | | application. |
24952 | | |
24953 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24954 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24955 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24956 | | |
24957 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24958 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24959 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24960 | | the application's configuration. |
24961 | | |
24962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24963 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24964 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24965 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24966 | | |
24967 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24968 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24969 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24970 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24971 | | be defined. |
24972 | | |
24973 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24974 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24975 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24976 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24977 | | is not set too. |
24978 | | |
24979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24980 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24981 | | set. |
24982 | | |
24983 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24984 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24985 | | the request. |
24986 | | |
24987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24988 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24989 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24990 | | |
24991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24992 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24993 | | script to process the request. |
24994 | | |
24995 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24996 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24997 | | |
24998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24999 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
25000 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
25001 | | |
25002 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25003 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
25004 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
25005 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
25006 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
25007 | | |
25008 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25009 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
25010 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
25011 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
25012 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
25013 | | side. |
25014 | | |
25015 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25016 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
25017 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
25018 | | connected to. |
25019 | | |
25020 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25021 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
25022 | | |
25023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020025024 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
25025 | | current HAProxy version. |
25026 | | |
25027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020025028 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
25029 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
25030 | | |
25031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25032
25033
2503410.3. Limitations
25035------------------
25036
25037The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
25038way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
25039during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
25040establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
25041application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
25042or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
25043message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
25044these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
25045and HTTP servers under the same backend.
25046
25047Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
25048request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
25049requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
25050
25051About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
25052into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
25053fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
25054"http-request" ones.
25055
25056Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
25057FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
25058processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
25059must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
25060here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010025061
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025062
2506311. Address formats
25064-------------------
25065
25066Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
25067address.
25068
25069This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
25070The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
25071of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
25072equivalent is '::'.
25073
25074Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
25075is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
25076
25077This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
25078family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
25079
25080Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
25081configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
25082use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
25083'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
25084
25085Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
25086socket type and the transport method.
25087
25088
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002508911.1. Address family prefixes
25090-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025091
25092'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
25093
25094'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
25095 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
25096 listening.
25097
25098'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
25099 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
25100 on the statement using this address, a port or
25101 a port range may or must be specified.
25102
25103'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25104 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
25105 using this address, a port or a port range
25106 may or must be specified.
25107
25108'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25109 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
25110 using this address, a port or a port range
25111 may or must be specified.
25112
25113'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
25114 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
25115 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
25116 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
25117 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
25118 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
25119
25120'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
25121 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
25122 start by slash '/'.
25123
25124
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002512511.2. Socket type prefixes
25126--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025127
25128Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
25129type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
25130this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
25131This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
25132but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
25133
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025134Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
25135use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
25136sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
25137known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
25138and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025139
25140If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
25141they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
25142report this to the maintainers.
25143
25144'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25145 to "stream"
25146
25147'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25148 to "datagram".
25149
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025150'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25151 method to "stream".
25152
25153
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025154
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002515511.3. Protocol prefixes
25156-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025157
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025158'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25159 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25160 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25161 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25162 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025163 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25164 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025165
25166'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25167 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25168 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25169 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25170 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025171 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25172 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025173
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025174'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25175 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25176 socket type and transport method is forced to
25177 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25178 this address, a port or a port range can or
25179 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25180 of 'stream+ip@'.
25181
25182'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25183 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25184 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25185 statement using this address, a port or port
25186 range can or must be specified.
25187 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25188
25189'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25190 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25191 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25192 statement using this address, a port or port
25193 range can or must be specified.
25194 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25195
25196'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25197 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25198 socket type and transport method is forced to
25199 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25200 this address, a port or a port range can or
25201 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25202 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25203
25204'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25205 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25206 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25207 the statement using this address, a port or
25208 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025209 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025210
25211'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25212 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25213 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25214 the statement using this address, a port or
25215 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025216 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025217
25218'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25219 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25220 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25221
25222'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25223 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25224 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25225
25226In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25227QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025229/*
25230 * Local variables:
25231 * fill-column: 79
25232 * End:
25233 */